Samsung GSM Smartphone Galaxy S II Plus I9105 Android GT-I9105P - Mode d'emploi - Manuel de l'utilisateur - Manuels
Liste des manuels APPLE Liste des produits Sony Liste des produits Dell Liste des Manuels Samsung Listes des Manuels Konica Minolta
Manuels Utilisateurs Samsung :
Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Series-5-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-H01ZA-Manuels
Samsung-Portables-et-peripheriques-Ordinateur-portable-Series-5-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-H01ZA-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5570-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Combines-Refrigerateur-Combine-RB29FEJNDWW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Star-noir-Open-market-GT-S5600-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-Table-induction-2-zones-7-2-KW-CTN364N006-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-SMART-Camera-WB250F-SAMSUNG-WB250F-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37B530-LE37B530P7W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12NSBN-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F90WP-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D550WXZF-serie-5-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D550C1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D4003BW-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-SH24TA6D-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH200WHXES-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C457C6H-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22A455C1D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22ES5000-ZF-Slim-LED-22-SMART-TV-UE22ES5000W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-152B-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-BX2240W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-40-UE40D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE40D5000PW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Jetnoir-Open-market-GT-S8000-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-64-PS64D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS64D8000FS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7510-M16-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5750E-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-360-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-5637FR-SCX-5637FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-775ND-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RV510I-NP-RV510-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T24B300-T24B300EW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-16ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-1660-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T23A750-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-DVD-DVD-D530WXZF-serie-5-DVD-D530-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Ultra-rouge-open-market-GT-S8300-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-N140-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS05FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-T01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26B350F1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A465C1M-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT63VBPN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE52A568-LE52A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22B650-LE22B650T6W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS58B680-PS58B680T6W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A465-LE32A465C1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C452C4H-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-Cathodique-WS32V54N-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-T27B750EW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-23-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-S23A350H-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL100-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-BX2231-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Combines-RL34HGMG-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18PSBX-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH18AP2X-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH035FJEA-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGEN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-LE40A796-LE40A796R2M-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09UGAX-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NS0351DXEA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-32-LE32D550WXZF-serie-5-HD-TV-LCD-TV-LE32D550K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE19C4000PW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A536T1F-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-55-Moniteur-LED-UD55A-mur-d-image-bord-fin-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6000-UE46C6000RW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimantes-Photos-SPP-2040-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-16ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-3205-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-460DR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12UGBN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8240NA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37B653T5P-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26A456C2D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A426-PS42A426C1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE19B450C4H-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C5100QW-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18KBAX-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH060FXEA3A-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C6900VS-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXCSH028EE-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXTJH036EE-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A457C1D-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGAN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S03FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S05FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-S04FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A04FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S07FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300V5AH-NP300V5A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AI-NP300E7A-A04FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X3D-A04FR
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T03FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP355V5C-NP355V5C-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-7-Gamer-700G7A-NP700G7A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S08FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-A05FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T05FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP500A2D-S02FR-2-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C8700XS-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6750WS-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6200TS-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B550-PS50B550T4W-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-S04FR-manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-RVXMHF050EA-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9103-manuels
Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-MZ-7TD120-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-ES4200-ZFHT-ES4200-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300V3AH-NP300V3A-S02FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S06FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-NP350V5C-S07FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie%209-900X1A-NP900X1A-A01FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1AXE-700T1A-A02FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A01FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-XE500T1C-A04FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E7AH-NP300E7A-S0DFR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X3C-NP900X3C-A03FR-manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-F800BP-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-5-550P7C-NP550P7C-T03FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4B-NP900X4B-A01FR-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5369-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE700T1A-XE700T1A-HF1FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-T06FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-NP900X3D-A05FR-NP900X3D-A05FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-S0AFR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24A650S-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27C650D-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B970D-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GS1CW-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-H02FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-S08FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X3C-A05FR-NP900X3C-A05FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP500A2D-S02FR-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-N7100-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D8000FS-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D7000LS-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS43E450-ZF-PLASMA-43-HD-TV-PS43E450A1W-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Star-2-noir-Open-market-GT-S5620-manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S3500-noir-Open-market-GT-S3500-manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NS071SDXEA-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A626-LE37A626A3M-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500C21-XE500C21-AZ2FR-manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5C-NP300E5C-T02FR-manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-27-UE27D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE27D5000NW-2-manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1130-B.manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S03FR.manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1310-NRJ-Mobile-GT-E1310B.manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E2220.manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12TSBN.manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-C3750.manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E2550D.manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ12FAN
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ES60-SAMSUNG-ES60.manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12KBAN-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH020FNEA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6570S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3D-UE32ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6560S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32ES6100W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D6300WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D6300SS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D8000YS-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH052FWEA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37C530-LE37C530F1W.manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5620.manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09KBBN.manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-51-PS51D550WXZF-serie-5-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51D550C1W.manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-F480G.manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5AH-NP300E5A-S0CFR.manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6710S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-32-UE32D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D6500VS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22ES5410-ZF-Slim-LED-22-SMART-TVUE22ES5410W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D8000YQ-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV18UGAN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C490-PS50C490B3W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH068FXEA4-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS51D6900DS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D450G1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A676-PS50A676T1M-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH035FEEA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6540S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C8700-UE55C8790XS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6570WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6530S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6560S-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I8190-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GI1CW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100P-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32S86BD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42C96HD-PS-42C96HD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32T51B-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A456-PS42A456P2D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-46-UE46D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D5000PW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS59D530A5W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C6700-UE32C6700US-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-43-PS43D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-PDP-TVPS43D450A2W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B7000-UE46B7000WW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE32D5000PW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS43D490A1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-22-UE22ES5400WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C350D1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C6000RH-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-ES6000-ZF-Lecteur-Blu-Ray-3D-SMART-HUB-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH4000-ZF-LED-32-HD-TV-UE32EH4000W-Manuals-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5000PW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19C450MR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S19C200NW-Manuels
Samsung-InformatiqueMoniteur-LCD-S19C450MW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000PW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5000NH-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG32EA590LS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450-LE32C450E1W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-Mistral-AQV09PSBN-User-Manuals-Manuel
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26D4003BW-User-Manuals-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS42A466-PS42A466P2M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26A466-LE26A466C2M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C6970-PS50C6970YS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Telephone-coulissant-Samsung-S5200-bleu-SFRGT-S5200-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A456-LE32A456C2D-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12UGAX-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH160PHXEA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS50C7000YW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-22-UE22D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE22D5000NW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5380-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P3100-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Galaxy-Tab-GT-P1000-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Nexus-noir-Open-market-GT-I9250-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9000-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-GT-N7000-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C430C4W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH052FJEA-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C8700XS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS63B680-PS63B680T6W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C630-LE40C630K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6100W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Oreillette-bluetooth-Kit-Pieton-Bluetooth-HM1700-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A577P2M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS64E8000-ZF-PLASMA-64-SMART-INTERACTION-3DPS64E8000GS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-B1930N-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32B651-LE32B651T3P-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-27-UE27D5000WXZF-serie-5-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE27D5000NW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B7000-UE40B7000WW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6500VH-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-Cathodique-CW29Z504N-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A856-LE40A856S1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3DUE40ES8000S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22B450-LE22B450C4W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE39EH5003W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40EH6030W-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A437T2D-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12PWAN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TVUE46ES5500W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37C530F1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5300W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-INTERACTION-3DUE40ES7000S-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXWNH022EE-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Oreillette-bluetooth-Kit-Mains-Libres-Bluetooth-HF1000-BHF1000-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-Cassette-4-voies-MH035FMEA-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV09PSBX-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D550K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6100W-AQV09PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450-LE26C450E1W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-Mistral-AQV09PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH4000-ZF-LED-32-HD-TV-UE32EH4000W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE60EH6000S-Manuels
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo 3D UE32D6300SS
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LCD LE32A437T2D
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV PDP PS50A466 PS50A466P2M
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LED UE46EH5300W
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LED UE37C6000UE37C6000RW
Samsung Informatique Moniteur LCD 770TFT
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные Плазма 51" cерия 5 Full HD PS51E530 PS51E530A3W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE46EH5000W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE46D5000PW Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные Плазма 42" Серия 4 HD PS42C431A2 PS42C431A2W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные PS42A410C3 Russe
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LCD LE40B651LE40B651T3W
Samsung TV Audio / Vidéo TV LCD LE40B651LE40B651T3W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE55B7000WW Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UE40ES7500S Russe
Samsung Мобильные телефоны Мобильные телефоны C3510 TVGT-C3510T Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные PS42B430P2W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UE46D7000LS Russe
Samsung Мобильные телефоны Смартфоны Samsung S6012 GT-S5830I Russe
Samsung Мобильные телефоны Смартфоны GT-S5830I Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника ЖК-телевизоры LE40C530F1W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UA55D6600WR Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника Плазменные Плазма 43" cерия 4 HD PS43E450PS43E450A1W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника ЖК-телевизоры LE32B450C4W Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника 3D UA40C7000WR Russe
Samsung Бытовая техника Настенное крепление Настенная сплит-система "Стандарт" AQ07RLAQ07RLN Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UA40C5000QR Russe
TV Audio / Vidéo 3D 40", UE40D6200WXZF, série 6, SMART TV, 3D, FULL HD, LED TV UE40D6200TS
Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры LED телевизор 32" Серия 4 HD UE32C4000P UE32C4000PW Russe
Samsung Аудиотехника Видеотехника LED-телевизоры UE32D5000PW Russe
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YP-GI1EW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C430-PS50C430A1W-Francais-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50Q96HD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C5100QW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B7020WW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000PH-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ09UGFN-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-12-MP-Ecran-LCD-2-7-compact-essentiel-Samsung-ES80-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF1702NHWG-YLE-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-U100-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P5100-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E570-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5720RS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP700A3D-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-R200-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A457C1D-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS06FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS08FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-France-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-LED-UE40B7000WW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-lasercouleur-CLX-3185FN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-300-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-AS06FR-Francais-Manuels
Samsung-Monitors-2493HM-USA-Etats-Unis-Manuels
Samsung-Exhibit-4G-Android-Smartphone-SGH-T759-USA-Etats-Unis-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6100W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV12PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D7000LS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40C7700WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6500VQ-Manuels
Samsung-Refrigerators-26-CU-FT-FRENCH-DOOR-REFRIGERATOR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-QX510-NP-QX510-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5800P-Francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-Q35-NP-Q35T007-SEF-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-Francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-9201NA-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-9301NA-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-X420I-NP-X420-JA05FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-francais-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S5150-gold-Open-market-GT-S5150-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-Neo-Forte-EHS-Hybride-NH022NHXEA-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-S06FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-LED-19-D4003-Series-4-LED-TV%20-UE19D4003BW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Netbook-NP-N220-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-R519-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Inde-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8123NA-Manuels
Samsung-SCX-3400-Pakistan-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-ATIV-Smart-PC-XE500T1C-3G-XE500T1C-H01SG-Singapour-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-S06FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-LED-19-D4003-Series-4-LED-TV%20-UE19D4003BW-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Netbook-NP-N220-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-R519-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Inde-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SCX-8123NA-Manuels
Samsung-SCX-3400-Pakistan-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Notebook-ATIV-Smart-PC-XE500T1C-3G-XE500T1C-H01SG-Singapour-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-ML-1674-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55D6300SS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C430-PS50C430A1W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-S3100-gris-Open-market-GT-S3100-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32C4000-UE32C4000PW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-23-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T23A350-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32B350F1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-BD-P1600A-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Blu-ray-HT-C6930W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26C4000PW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R719NP-R719-XA01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-5-550P7C-NP550P7C-T02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Stockage-informatique-SSD-Basic-Kit-64-GoMZ-7PC064B-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Samsung-Smart-Camera-NX210-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Sans-sac-SC8850-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-gril-niche-380-mm-23-L-FG87SST-FG87SST-XEF-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-vaisselle-DW5363PGBSL-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-vaisselle-DW5363PGBWQ-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Feature-Phone-GT-E1175T-Anglais-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C530-LE46C530F1W-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Nexus-GT-I9250-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5800P-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-550-noir-Open-market-GT-I5500-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-DP700A3D-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-WB100-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-YH-820MW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S22B150N-Manuels
Samsung-Stockage-informatique-Graveur-DVD-Slim-External-8X-DVD-Writer-SE-208AB-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Plaque-de-cuisson-CTN431SC0S-Manuels
24ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6250FX-Samsung-Manuels
32-UE32D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D6200TS-Samsung-Manuels
35-35ppm-Copieur-couleur-CLX-9350ND-Samsung-Manuels
Galaxy-Y-S5360-AndroidGT-S5360-Manuels-Utilisateur-et-Guides-Rapide-Samsung
Manuels-de-l-Utilisateur-19-UE19D4000WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LED-TV-UE19D4000NW-Samsung
Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-R730-Red-Gloss-NP-R730-JS01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-SGH-I320-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV510-NP-RV510-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7ANP300E7A-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-40-UE40D7000WXZF-serie-7-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D7000LS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E1150-rouge-Open-market-GT-E1150-Manuels
Samsung-Téléphone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT08FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-Style-Open-market-SGH-F480-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350V5C-NP350V5C-S03FR-Manuels
Samsung-RV511-NP-RV511-A06MA-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-R590-Crystal-NP-R590-JS01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R530E-NP-R530-JT50FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C630-LE32C630K1W-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-S850-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6530WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D6530WS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Player-City-blanc-Orange-GT-S5260P-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-PDP-2012-PS43E450A1R-43-inch-HD-Ready-Plasma-TV-Emirats-Arabes-Unis-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Robot-Aspirateur-Robot-2-murs-Virtuel-Noir-SR8895-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E2530-Open-market-GT-E2530-Manuels
Samsung-Peripheriques-pour-PC-Multifonctions-monochromes-SCX-3405W-Manuels
Samsung-I9300-GT-I9300-Afrique-du-Nord-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels
Samsung-Camera-Camcorder-Compact-ST66-SAMSUNG-ST66-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-Mono-Multi-function-SCX-3405FW-Hong-Kong-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Samsung-GALAXY-S-III-GALAXY-S3-GT-I9300-Singapour-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Music-GT-S6010-Royaume-Uni-Manuels
Samsung-Home-Appliance-Top-Mounted-Fridge-Freezer-SR365TSS-Nouvelle-Zelande-Manuels
Samsung-Home-Appliance-Top-Loader-Top-Load-Washing-Machine-WA10W9-Singapour-Manuels
Samsung-electromenagers-Front-Loader-WF710Y4BKWQ-EN-Belgique-Manuels
Samsung-PC-Office-LCD-LED-S22C200BW-Hong-Kong-Manuels
Samsung-Camaras-Alta-definicion-Videocamara-HD-F80HMX-F80SP-Espagne-Manuels
Samsung-Mobile-Phone-Smart-Phone-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Emirats-Arabes-Unis-Manuels
Samsung-Sprzet-komputerowy-i-Drukarki-Notebooki-NP-R710-AS04PL-Pologne-Manuels
Samsung-Informatica-LCD-2043SW-Portugues-Portugais-Bresil-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-3D-Blu-ray-HT-E3550-English-Anglais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X1B-NP900X1B-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0CFR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT50QMSW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46EH6030W-Manuels
Samsung-Home-Appliance-Side-by-Side-RSA1STMG-Arabe-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS59D6900DS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7C-NP700Z7C-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-Side-By-Side-RS6178UGDSR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-S730-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-E590-Manuels
20ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-6220FX-Samsung-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-5100P-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-XE500T1C-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT0BFR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R610-NP-R610-FS02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-RC710E-NP-RC710-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-francais-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF5FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C520-Hello-Kitty-Open-marketS-GH-C520-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-Player-mini-2GT-C3310-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP530U3C-NP530U3C-A06FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5C-NP700Z5C-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-Camera-EK-GC100-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-SGH-Z360-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A856-LE46A856S1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B620T2WXXC-LE40B620R3W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A568-LE40A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQ18FAN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22D450G1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D6200TS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4C-NP900X4C-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-NL22B-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-S0BFR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46A568-LE46A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE65ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-65-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE65ES8000S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-C6625-gris-Open-market-GT-C6625-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46B8000WW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Corby-Pro-rouge-Open-market-GT-B5310-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrigerateur-SBS-A-507-L-Blanc-RSA1TWP-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D430DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A626-LE40A626A3M-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-GT-C3310-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-C3520-GT-C3520-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-Refrig%C3%A9rateur-SBS-A-510-L-Inox-RSH5TERS-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-mono-23L-SILVER-ME82V-Manuels*
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40D503F7W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2165-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Side-By-Side-RSA1DTMG-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-SF-6900-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-C5530-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B300BL-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-HT-D4200-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730C-NP-R730-JB03FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-R-mix-YP-R1JCP-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-P2470HD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P1600-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J770-Open-market-SGH-J770-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Home-Cinema-Home-cinema-DVD-5.1-HT-D350WXZF-serie-3HT-D350-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-CLX-6200FX-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-Smart-Camera-WB850F-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z5AH-NP700Z5A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP305V5AD-NP305V5A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6530S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50A456-PS50A456P2D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6570WS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-22-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T22A300-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-S2-YP-S2QB-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-24ppm-Imprimante-laser-mono-ML-2580N-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-3710ND-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40D5003BW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-P2500-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R710-NP-R710-ASS1FR-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-SAMSUNG-PL101-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A566P1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46D550K1W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Plusieurs-Pieces-MH026FWEA-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV07PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50B850-PS50B850Y1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37D5000ZF-UE37D5000PW-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-NH300WHXES-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40ES5700S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-60-UE60D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE60D8000YS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32D403E2W-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-ST500-SAMSUNG-ST500-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-S5610-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S3-GT-I9300-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-27-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T27A300-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1170-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40R86BD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE22C350-LE22C350D1W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-J700-SGH-J700G-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-Micro-ondes-Gril-23L-SILVER-GS89F-1SPGS89F-1SP-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-300E5A-NP300E5A-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-RC-RC730-NP-RC730-S05FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-Multifonction-monochrome-SCX-3405W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-de-bureau-23-Serie-7-All-In-One-700A3B-DP700A3B-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-RC-RC530-NP-RC530-S03FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-15-6-Serie-3-300E5-ANP300E5A-S08FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A568-LE37A568P3M-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-24-Serie-3-Moniteur-LED-TV-T24A350-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-G600-Open-market-SGH-G600-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Haute-Definition-HMX-QF20BP-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-PL90-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C550-LE32C550J1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE23R86BD-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE26C450E1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A436T1D-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-GT-E1151-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-P3YP-P3JCB-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Couleur-16-4ppm-Multifonction-laser-couleur-CLX-3185W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique%20Multifonction-Monochrome-24ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4824FN-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-11-6-Serie-7-Slate-PC-700T1A-3G-XE700T1A-H01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9100G-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-F250-Open-market-SGH-F250-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730-NP-R730-JA05FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE26D4003BW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-7-Gamer-700G7A-NP700G7A-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Nouveau-Serie-9-900X3C-NP900X3C-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4.0-Blanc-8GoYP-G1CW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Micro-Chaine-Hi-Fi-Micro-chaine-MM-D470DWXZF-serie-4-DVD-MM-D470D-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Solid-B2100-rouge-Open-market-GT-B2100-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U3B-NP530U3B-A02FR-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-Chat-335-gris-Open-market-GT-S3350-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Xcover-GT-S5690-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B530P7W-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-WF0702NBE-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55C7700-UE55C7700WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-Blu-ray-BD-E8300-ZF-Enregistreur-Blu-Ray-320-Go-SMART-HUB-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE46C750-LE46C750R2W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Enregistreur-DVD-DVD-SH893-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-NX-Systeme-NX-NX100-14-6-MP-Ecran-7-6cm-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-Imprimante-couleur-CLP-365-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-3-305E5A-NP305E5A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Lecteur-MP3-MP4-Samsung-Q3YP-Q3CB-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-B3310bleu-Open-market-GT-B3310-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-U600-Open-market-SGH-U600B-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Samsung-E250-Open-market-SGH-E250-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S24B350H-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP350E7C-NP350E7C-S0BFR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES7000-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE55ES7000S-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP900X4D-NP900X4D-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP700Z7CH-NP700Z7C-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z3A-NP700Z3A-S02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-SUR40-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE32D6510WS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-300V3A-NP300V3A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ultra-Mobilite-NP-NC10-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I5800-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Monochrome-Imprimante-monochrome-ML-2160-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R720E-NP-R720-JS03FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R730CE-NP-R730-JT07FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP-R620E-NP-R620-JS02FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32D5720RS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP550P5C-NP550P5C-T04FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D8000WXZF-serie-8-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE55D8000YS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-17-3-Serie-3-300E7A-NP300E7A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-RV-RV515-NP-RV515-S04FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3DUE46ES6710S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40ES6900-ZF-Slim-LED-40-SMART-TV-3DUE40ES6900S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-HG40EA590LS-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Electromenager-Micro-ondes-CE117PPT-Manuels
Samsung-TV-AV-3D-TV-TV-UN50ES6350F-Coree-du-Sud-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Multifonction-Monochrome-19ppm-Multifonction-laser-mono-SCX-4200-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-32-32ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-770ND-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Imprimante-Couleur-16-4ppm-Imprimante-laser-couleur-CLP-320-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-32-UE32D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE32D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9000-RW8-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-TC220W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9001-M8-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-Wi-Fi-GT-P5110-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels-Mode-d-emploi
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Galaxy-S-Advance-GT-I9070P-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-LE40C750-LE40C750R2W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32ES5500-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-UE32ES5500W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A676-LE40A676A1M-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5230-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40EH5300W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46B651-LE46B651T3W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE22D5010NW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE32EH5000-ZF-LED-32-FULL-HD-UE32EH5000W-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-blanc-SFR-GT-N7000-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-7.0-Wi-FiGT-P3110-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P7300-M16-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-Samsung-Galaxy-Note-noir-SFRGT-N7000-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE50ES6900S-ZF-Slim-LED-50-SMART-TV-3D-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55D6300SS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-46-UE46D6500WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE46D6500VS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32A676-LE32A676A1M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-PS63C7700-PS63C7700YS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-55-UE55D6200WXZF-serie-6-SMART-TV-3D-FULL-HD-LED-TVUE55D6200TS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE55ES6540S-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE40D6750WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE32C450E1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40C530-LE40C530F1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-3D-UE46D6750WS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40B6000-UE40B6000VW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A556P1F-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE46C6710-UE46C6710US-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE40C5100QW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-PDP-PS50C530-PS50C530C1W-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-14-Serie-5-ULTRA-530U4B-NP530U4B-S01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Photo-Camescope-Compact-Samsung-DV90-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-Refrigerateur-DP-A306-L-Silver-RT37GBSS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-460DR-2-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT45JSTS-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME32B-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Samsung-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT41MASW-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Tablette-GT-P6800-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-C24B550U-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-S5839I-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Lave-linge-frontal-Lave-linge-EcoBubble-12kg-1400tours-WF1124XBC-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Ampli-Tuner-AV-HW-E551-ZF-Barre-de-son-Format-46-Convertible-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Phone-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-NP300E5C-NP300E5C-AF2FR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Climatiser-Une-Piece-AQV24PSBN-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE46C630K1W-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LED-UE37B6000VW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40A466-LE40A466C2M-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE37A676-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Pompe-a-chaleur-Air-Eau-AVXDUH112EE-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-TV-LCD-LE40B651T3P-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Autres-Samsung-S5220GT-S5220-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-Serie-9-900X4C-NP900X4C-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59NBPN-Manuels
Samsung-Telephone-Mobile-Smartphones-GT-I9305-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Moniteur-LCD-S27B750V-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Refrigerateur-une-porte-RZ90HAWW-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME75B-Manuels
Samsung-Electromenager-Double-portes-RT59PMSW-Manuels
Samsung-Informatique-Ordinateur-Portable-13-3Serie-9-900X3A-NP900X3A-A01FR-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME40B-Manuels
Samsung-SGH-D500-Telephone-Mobile-GSM-Manuels
Samsung-Table-induction-3-foyers-7-2-KW-CTN463NC01-CTN463NC01-XEF-Manuels
Samsung-RR92HAWW-Refrigerateur-une-porte-Monochrome-Manuels
Samsung-ML-2160-Imprimante-Monochrome-Manuels
Samsung-TV-Audio-Video-Moniteur-Grande-taille-ME46B-Manuels
Samsung-LE37A466-LE37A466C2M-Manuels
Samsung-Zephyr-AQV09YWAN-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-10.1-GT-P5100-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-2-7.0-GT-P3100-Manuels
Samsung-51-PS51E490WXZF-serie-4-3D-HD-TV-PDP-TV-PS51E490B1W-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Note-II-GT-N7100-Manuels
Samsung-AQV12KBBN-Pologne-Manuels
Samsung-ML-2165W-Roumanie-Manuels
Samsung-Notebook-Serie-7-Chronos-700Z5C-S01-NP700Z5C-S01DE-Manuels
Samsung-Player-One-noir-Open-market-GT-S5230-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S-SCL-noir-Open-market-GT-I9003-M4-Manuels
Samsung-Samsung-Galaxy-Pro-gris-Open-market-GT-B7510-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Gio-noir-SFR-GT-S5660-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Teos-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5800-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Spica-noir-Bouygues-GT-I5700-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7610-noir-Open-market-GT-B7610-Manuels
Samsung-S5610-GT-S5610-Manuels
Samsung-LE32C650-LE32C650L1W-Manuels
Samsung-N145Plus-NP-N145P-Manuels
Samsung-NP20-NP20FK02BG-SEF-Manuels
Samsung-GT-S5570_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_110726_Screen.pdf-Manuels
Samsung-GT-I9070P_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_120710_Screen.pdf-Manuels
Samsung-GT-I9300_UM_Open_Icecream_Fre_Rev.1.2_120725_Screen.pdf-Manuels
Samsung-Gainable-Slim-MH026FEEA-Manuels
Samsung-40-UE40D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE40D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-UE46C8700-UE46C8790XS-Manuels
Samsung-UE46ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-TV-3D-UE46ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-2012_Skype_Eng-0316-1-Manuels
Samsung-UE75ES9000S-Slim-LED-75-SMART-Interaction-3D-Manuels
Samsung-Refrigerateur-1porteA-350-L-Blanc-RR82FHSW-Manuels
Samsung-UE26EH4000-ZF-LED-26-HD-TV-UE26EH4000W-Manuels
Samsung-E-MANUAL-X9DVBEU4E-ENG-Manuel
Samsung-GT-S5360_UM_Open_Gingerbread_Fre_Rev.1.0_111130_Screen-Manuel
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuel
Samsung-Galaxy-Tab-10-1-GT-P7500-M16-Manuels
Samsung-Lecteur-Multimedia-Galaxy-S-WiFi-4-0-Blanc-8Go-YP-G1CW-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-551-noir-Open-marketGT-I5510-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Note-10-1-GT-N8000-Manuels
Samsung-GALAXY-S-II-LTE-SC-03D-JP-Manuels
Samsung-GALAXY-Note-SC-05D-JP-Manuels
Samsung-NP-R530-NP-R530-JA02FR-Manuels
Samsung-UE40C6000-UE40C6000RW-Manuels
Samsung-Congelateur-1porteA-277-L-Blanc-RZ80FHSW-Manuels
Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-GT-B5310-Manuels
Samsung-32-LE32D450WXZF-serie-4-HD-TV-LCD-TV-Manuels
Samsung-46-UE46D5700WXZF-serie-5-SMART-TV-FULL-HD-LED-TV-UE46D5700RS-Manuels
Samsung-UE46ES8000-ZF-Slim-LED-46-SMART-INTERACTION-3D-UE46ES8000S-Manuels
Samsung-UE55ES6300-ZF-Slim-LED-55-SMART-TV-3D-UE55ES6300S-Manuels
Samsung-LE46A676-LE46A676A1M-Manuels
Samsung-UE46C7700-UE46C7700WS-Manuels
Samsung-Refrigerateur-DP-A275-L-Blanc-RT34GBSW-Manuels
Samsung-UE32ES6710-ZF-Slim-LED-32-SMART-TV-3DUE32ES6710S-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-Ace-noir-Open-market-GT-S5830-Manuels
Samsung-GALAXY-Tab-GT-P1000-GT-P1000-M16-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-Pro-B7330-noir-Open-market-GT-B7330-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-Lite-noir-Orange-GT-B7300-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-S2-GT-I9100-Manuels
Samsung-Nexus-S-noir-Open-market-GT-I9023-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFRGT-I8000-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-II-noir-SFR-GT-I8000-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-7-noir-Open-market-GT-I8700-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-noir-Bouygues-GT-I7500-Manuels
Samsung-Galaxy-mini-gris-Open-market-GT-S5570-Manuels
Samsung-XE700T1A-HF1FR-Manuels
17,3" Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S01FR - Manuels
40", UE40D6500WXZF, série 6, SMART TV, 3D, FULL HD, LED TV - UE40D6500VS - Manuels
Micro-chaîne, MM-D330DWXZF, série 3 - MM-D330 - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy Ace noir - Open market - GT-S5830 - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy S II noir - Open market - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy S III - GT-I9300 - Manuels
Samsung Galaxy S noir - Open market - GT-I9000 - Manuels
Série 3 300E7A - NP300E7A-S03FR - Manuels
UE55ES8000/ZF, Slim LED 55", SMART INTERACTION, 3D - UE55ES8000S - Manuels
16/4ppm Imprimante laser couleur CLP-310 Manuels
16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3170FN Manuels
16/4ppm Multifonction lasercouleur CLX-3185FW Manuels Samsung
16/4ppm Multifonction laser couleur CLX-3185 Manuels Samsung
samsung-Wave-II-noir-Open-market-GT-S8530-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-noir-Open-market-GT-S8500-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-M-noir-Open-market-GT-S7250-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-578-noir-Open-market-GT-S5780-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-533-noir-Open-market-GT-S5330-Manuels
Samsung-Wave-3-noir-Open-market-GT-S8600-Manuels
Samsung-Player-HD-noir-Open-market-GT-I8910-Manuels
Samsung-Player-Duo-noir-Open-market-SGH-D980-Manuels
Samsung-Player-Addict-noir-Open-market-SGH-I900-Manuels
Samsung-Omnia-W-noir-Open-market-GT-I8350-Manuels
Samsung - Aspirateur robot Navibot SR8845
Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86G0 gris foncé/fuchsia
Samsung - Aspirateur sans sac SC4780 noir
Samsung - Four micro-ondes MW73B - blanc
SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 36 L - Micro ondes 36 L - CP1395ES
SAMSUNG - Micro ondes 42 L - Micro ondes 42 L - CQ1570U
Samsung - Micro-ondes combiné CE117PT-B
SAMSUNG - Micro-ondes Grill simultané GS89F-1SP
Samsung 305U1A 11,6" LED + Office Famille et Etudiant 2010 1 poste
Samsung Aspirateur sans sac EcoStyle SC86H0 gris clair/bleu
Samsung B1930HD 18.5" LCD TNT HD
Samsung Bac papier supplémentaire ML-S3710A - 520 feuilles
Samsung Câble Adaptateur HDTV pour Galaxy Tab 8.9" / 10.1"
Samsung Câble data pour téléphones mobiles Samsung
Samsung Caméra additionnelle de vidéosurveillance SEB-1015RWP EX
Samsung caméra Skype CY-STC1100
Samsung Ch@t335 - GT-S3350 - Noir
Samsung Chargeur allume-cigares micro-USB
Samsung chargeur de voyage pour SGH-P260 et SGH-G600 - Modèle Noir
Samsung Chargeur secteur de voyage micro-USB
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-325 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLP-325 WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0
Samsung CLP-620ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLX-3185 + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir
Samsung CLX-3185FW WiFi + Toner Samsung CLT-K4072S Noir + MCL Samar câble imprimante USB 2.0
Samsung CLX-3185W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung CLX-6220FX - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung Coque silicone Croisillons pour nexus S
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128D 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 128 Go MZ-7PC128N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256D 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 256 Go MZ-7PC256N 830 Series
Samsung Disque Dur interne SSD 64 Go MZ-7PC064D 830 Series
Samsung dongle Wi-Fi WIS12ABGNX
Samsung DP7000A3B 23" LED Tactile USB 3.0
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire + 1 Camel
Samsung Duo de 2 coques pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - 1 Noire matelassée + 1 Rose
Samsung DV300F Argent/Rouge - WiFi
Samsung EcoBlue SC61E0 bleu azur
Samsung ES30 Noir + Carte SD 2 Go
Samsung Etui coque pour Galaxy Note - Noir
Samsung Etui cuir pour Galaxy S II - Noir
Samsung Etui flap en cuir pour Samsung Galaxy II I9100 - Noir
Samsung Eui cuir pour i9000 Galaxy S
Samsung Galaxy Ace s5830 (sous Androïd)
Samsung Galaxy Mini (sous Android)
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Blanc
Samsung Galaxy S2 (I9100G) - Noir
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go + Western Digital My Book Live 1 To Ethernet
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Tab 10,1" TFT Noir 16 Go 3G
Samsung Galaxy Tab 8,9" TFT Blanc 32 Go Wifi
Samsung Galaxy Xcover s5690 (sous Androïd) - Smartphone Samsung Solide certifié IP67
Samsung Galaxy Y Pro B5510 (sous Androïd)
Samsung Galaxy Y Young s5360 (sous Androïd)
Samsung Graveur DVD Externe Wifi - SE-208BW - Noir
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 10,1"
Samsung Housse Folio pour Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung I9103 Galaxy R (sous Android)
Samsung Kit de connexion USB & SD pour Galaxy Tab 10.1"
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SDE-3003P/EX
Samsung Kit de vidéosurveillance tout-en-un SME-4220
Samsung Kit Etui + Clavier Bluetooth pour Galaxy Tab 10,1" - Brun foncé
Samsung kit piéton filaire stéréo Jack 3,5 mm
Samsung Lot de 2 protections d'écran pour Galaxy S2 - Transparente/Miroir
Samsung Lot de 2 Protections d'écran pour i9000 Galaxy S
Samsung Lunettes 3D SSG-3050GB
Samsung ME82V Micro-onde monofonction
SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE117APT B
SAMSUNG Micro-ondes combiné CE137NEMX
Samsung ML-2165 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2165W - Imprimante WiFi
Samsung ML-2545 - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-2955DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung ML-2955ND - Imprimante Ethernet
Samsung ML-3310D - Imprimante Monochrome
Samsung ML-3710DW - Imprimante Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung MV800 Noir + Etui Zadig & Voltaire Noir
Samsung NP300E7A-S03FR 17,3" LED
Samsung NP700Z5A-S02FR 15,6" LED
Samsung NX 60 mm f/2.8 ED OIS SSA Macro i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX 85 mm f/1.4 ED SSA i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 16 mm f/2.4 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 20 mm f/2.8 i-Function; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX Pancake 30 mm f/2.0; dédié Boîtiers Hybrides
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 18 - 55 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 OIS + Flash SEF-8A NG8
Samsung NX200 Noir + Obj. Samsung NX 20 - 50 mm f/3.5 - 5.6 ED i-Function + Flash SEF-8A NG8
Samsung Oreillette Bluetooth HM1200
Samsung Pack d'accessoire pour Galaxy S II I9100
Samsung Pack étui cuir + chargeur + protection d'écran pour Galaxy S
Samsung PL210 Noir + Carte mémoire Lexar MicroSDHC 8 Go
Samsung Player mini 2 c3310 - Gris Métal
Samsung Player Mini C3300 - Noir
Samsung Port parallèle ML-PAR100 pour imprimante
Samsung RF712 E7P-C7261 17,3" LED 3D Blu-Ray USB 3.0 + lunettes
Samsung S24B300HL Moniteur 23,6" LED
Samsung SC4790 - Aspirateur sans sac - traineau - rouge
Samsung SCX-3405 - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405F - Imprimante Multifonctions
Samsung SCX-3405FW - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi & Ethernet
Samsung SCX-3405W - Imprimante Multifonctions WiFi
Samsung SCX-4729FD - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SCX-4729FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet & WiFi
Samsung SCX-5737FW - Imprimante Multifonctions Ethernet
Samsung SE-084D graveur DVD externe slim USB 2.0
Samsung SE208AB Graveur DVD externe USB 2.0
Samsung SLB-11A pour Samsung WB1000
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 10,1"
Samsung Station d'accueil pour tablette Galaxy Tab 8,9"
Samsung station d'accueil SSD-760 E2/EUR
Samsung SyncMaster C23A550U 23" LED
Samsung SyncMaster C23A750X 23" LED
Samsung Syncmaster S23A700D 23" LED 3D
Samsung SyncMaster S24A350H 24" LED
Samsung Syncmaster T22A550 21,5" LED Tuner TNT HD
Samsung Système de vidéosurveillance Baby Monitor SEW-3022WP/ EX
Samsung T22A350 21,5" LED Tuner TNT
Samsung Toner MLT-D101S pour imprimantes Samsung SCX-3405 & ML-2165 - Noir
Samsung UE32ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung UE46ES6710 LED 3D blanc
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" + Microsoft Explorer Touch Mouse - Souris BlueTrack sans fil
Samsung ultrabook NP530U3B-A02 13,3" LED USB 3.0
Samsung ultrabook NP530U4B-S01FR 14" LED USB 3.0
Samsung Viseur électronique EVF10
Samsung WIS09ABGN LinkStick WLAN-Adapter
Samsung WMN250M accroche murale
Samsung YP-Q3 rose 8 Go + Casque JVC HA-S155-P rose
This user manual includes detailed usage instructions for your camera. Please read this manual thoroughly. User Manual NX5 Ä Click a topic Quick reference Contents Basic functions Basic shooting Extended shooting functions Playback/Editing Camera settings menu Appendixes2 Health and safety information Always comply with the following precautions and usage tips to avoid dangerous situations and ensure peak performance of your camera. Warning—situations that could cause injury to yourself or others Caution—situations that could cause damage to your camera or other equipment Note—notes, usage tips, or additional information Do not use your camera near flammable or explosive gases and liquids Do not use your camera near fuels, combustibles, or flammable chemicals. Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or explosive materials in the same compartment as the camera or its accessories. Keep your camera away from small children and pets Keep your camera and all accessories out of the reach of small children and animals. Small parts may cause choking or serious injury if swallowed. Moving parts and accessories may present physical dangers as well. Prevent damage to subjects’ eyesight Do not use the flash in close proximity (closer than 1 m/3 ft) to people or animals. Using the flash too close to your subject’s eyes can cause temporary or permanent damage. Handle and dispose of batteries and chargers with care Use only Samsung-approved batteries and chargers. Incompatible batteries and chargers can cause serious injuries or damage to your camera. Never dispose of batteries in a fire. Follow all local regulations when disposing of used batteries. Never place batteries or cameras on or in heating devices, such as microwave ovens, stoves, or radiators. Batteries may explode when overheated. Handle and store your camera carefully and sensibly Do not allow your camera to get wet—liquids can cause serious damage. Do not handle your camera with wet hands. Water damage to your camera can void your manufacturer’s warranty. • • • • Safety warnings Safety precautions 3 Do not expose the camera to direct sunlight or high temperatures for an extended period of time. Prolonged exposure to sunlight or extreme temperatures can cause permanent damage to your camera’s internal components. Avoid using or storing your camera in dusty, dirty, humid, or poorly-ventilated areas to prevent damage to moving parts and internal components. Remove the batteries from your camera when storing it for an extended period of time. Installed batteries may leak or corrode over time and cause serious damage to your camera. Protect your camera from sand and dirt when using it on beaches or in other similar areas. Protect your camera from impact, shock, bending, or press of heavy goods when you connect either cable or power code. It may damage your camera or cable or cause by electric shock or fire. Exercise caution when connecting cables or adaptors and installing batteries and memory cards. Forcing the connectors, improperly connecting cables, or improperly installing batteries and memory cards can damage ports, connectors, and accessories. Do not insert foreign objects into any of your camera’s compartments, slots, or access points. Damage due to improper use may not be covered by your warranty. Do not use broken power cord, plug, or wall-outlet. It may cause by electric shock or fire. Protect batteries, chargers, and memory cards from damage Avoid exposing batteries or memory cards to very cold or very hot temperatures (below 0º C/32º F or above 40º C/104º F). Extreme temperatures can reduce the charging capacity of your batteries and can cause memory cards to malfunction. Prevent batteries from making contact with metal objects, as this can create a connection between the + and – terminals of your battery and lead to • • • • • • • • • • temporary or permanent battery damage. Prevent memory cards from making contact with liquids, dirt, or foreign substances. If dirty, wipe the memory card clean with a soft cloth before inserting in your camera. Turn off the camera when inserting or removing the memory card. Do not bend, drop, or subject memory cards to heavy impact or pressure. Do not use memory cards that have been formatted by other cameras or by a computer. Reformat the memory card with your camera. Never use a damaged charger, battery, or memory card. Use only Samsung-approved accessories Using incompatible accessories may damage your camera, cause injury, or void your warranty. Protect your camera’s lens Do not expose the lens to direct sunlight, as this may discolor the image sensor or cause it to malfunction. Protect your lens from fingerprints and scratches. Clean your lens with a soft, clean, debris-free lens cloth. Allow only qualified personnel to service your camera Do not allow unqualified personnel to service the camera or attempt to service the camera yourself. Any damage that results from unqualified service is not covered by your warranty. Ensure maximum battery and charger life Overcharging batteries may shorten battery life. After • • • • • • • • Important usage information 4 Basic functions 12 Learn about your camera’s layout, icons, and basic functions for shooting. Basic shooting 38 Learn how to take a photo by selecting a mode and how to record a video. Extended shooting functions 50 Learn about the options you can set in shooting mode. By using the shooting options, you can enjoy more customized pictures and movies. Playback/Editing 78 Learn how to play back photos, videos, and edit photos or videos. Also, learn how to connect your camera to your computer, photo printer, TV, or HDTV. Camera settings menu 103 The camera use environment can be set to a desired state by using the setup menu. Appendixes 109 Refer to settings, error messages, specifications, and maintenance tips. charging is finished, disconnect the cable from your camera. Over time, unused batteries will discharge and must be recharged before use. Disconnect chargers from power sources when not in use. Use batteries only for their intended purpose. Exercise caution when using the camera in humid environments When transferring the camera from a cold environment to a warm and humid one, condensation can form on the delicate electronic circuitry and memory card. In this situation, wait for at least 1 hour until all moisture has evaporated before using the camera. Check that the camera is operating properly before use The manufacturer takes no responsibility for any loss of files or damage that may result from camera malfunction or improper use. Copyright information Microsoft Windows and the Windows logo are registered trademarks of the Microsoft Corporation. HDMI, the HDMI logo and the term "High Definition Multimedia Interface" are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licencing LLC. • • • • • Organization of the user manual Camera specifications or contents of this manual may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of camera functions. For Open Source License information, refer to the “OpenSourceInfo.pdf” in the provided CD-ROM. • •5 Indications used in this manual Shooting mode Marking Smart Auto Program Aperture Priority Shutter Speed Priority Manual Night Portrait Landscape Scene Movie Shooting mode explanation shown next to the title This shows that the functions explained can only be selected from within the shooting mode. In the case of the mode, this corresponds to only part of the scene. Ex) Adjusting exposure (brightness) The diagram below illustrates the shooting mode dial on the camera body. To select a shooting mode, you rotate the dial until the mode you want lines up with the hash mark on the camera. The diagram below shows the status has been changed to ( ). Directional Keys in the User's Manual When explaining the steps needed for navigating the menu, the up, down, left and right directional arrows are shown below. Ex) Executing the 'Play' mode The user can check saved pictures and movies. 1 Press [ ] • Show most recently saved files. 2 Check the following pictures sequentially by using [X]. Adjusting the exposure (brightness) The images can be taken bright or dark according to the amount of light. In this case, appropriate adjustment can be made by controlling the amount of light entered into the lens. S Applying - S 0 S Applying + (Program), (Aperture priority), (Shutter priority), (Night), (Portrait), (Landscape), (Scene), or (Movie) mode. Currently selected shooting mode AF MF WB ISO [S] [T] [W] [X]6 Menu display used in this manual Menu display of the photo shooting mode Menu display of the movie shooting mode Ex) Setting the image quality of movie file 1 Set the mode dial to . 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Quality. 4 Select a desired image quality. Icons used in this manual Symbol Explanation Additional information about the function Safety warnings and precautions [ ] Indicates a camera button, for example: [Shutter] represents the shutter button. ( ) Shows the reference page → Display when selecting a menu or option within the step Example: Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Quality. (represents select Shooting 1 ( 1), and then Quality) * Comment explaining symbols Abbreviations used in this manual Abbreviations Explanation AF (Auto Focus) Auto focus BKT (Bracketing) Bracketing DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) Printing order mark EV (Exposure Value) Exposure value OIS (Optical Image Stabilization) Optical image stabilization ISO (International Standard for color negative film) Film sensitivity WB (White Balance) White balance 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Shooting 1( 1) Shooting 2( 2) Shooting 3( 3) User setup ( 1) Setting 1( 1) Setting 2( 2) Setting 3( 3) 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Shooting 1( 1) Shooting 2( 2) Shooting 3( 3)7 Pressing the shutter Half-press [Shutter]: press the shutter halfway down Press [Shutter]: press the shutter all the way down Half-press [Shutter] Press [Shutter] Subject, background, and composition Subject: the main object of a scene, such as a person, animal, or still life Background: the objects around the subject Composition: the combination of a subject and background Subjectuect Background Composition • • • • • Exposure (Brightness) The amount of light that enters your camera determines the exposure. You can alter the exposure with shutter speed, aperture value, and ISO speed. By altering the exposure, your photos will be darker or lighter. Normal exposure Overexposure (too bright) Expressions used in this manual8 Viewing files by category in Smart Album f 81 Deleting all files on the memory card f 83 Viewing files as a slide show f 84 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV f 92 Connecting your camera to a computer f 93 Adjusting sound and volume f 105 Adjusting the brightness of the display f 105 Changing the display language f 105 Setting the date and time f 107 Formatting the memory card f 106 Troubleshooting f 115 • • • • • • • • • • • Taking photos of people mode → Beauty Shot f47 Red-eye reduction f56 Face Detection AF f64 • • • Taking photos at night or in the dark mode f45 Flash setting options f55 ISO speed setting f59 • • • Taking action photos mode f42 Continuous, Burst shooting f73 • • Taking photos of text, insects, or flowers mode → Close-up shot f39 Using the White Balance f68 • • Adjusting the exposure (brightness) ISO speed setting f59 Adjusting exposure f66 Metering f67 BRK(Bracketing) f74 • • • • Applying a different effect Picture Wizard f75 Photo Style f88 • • Reducing camera shake • Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) f35 Quick reference9 Contents Basic functions ....................................................12 Unpacking ................................................................. 13 Title and role of each part .......................................... 14 Diopter adjustment dial/eye-cup/Status lamp ........... 16 Description for each part of the lens ......................... 17 Preparations before shooting .................................... 18 Charging the battery ................................................. 18 Installing the battery .................................................. 19 Installing the memory card ....................................... 20 Mounting/dismounting the lens ................................ 21 Connecting the strap ................................................ 22 Turning on the power and initialization ...................... 23 Icons ........................................................................ 25 Option/menu selection method ................................. 26 Using the dial ............................................................ 26 Using [Fn] ................................................................. 27 Setting the display and sound ................................... 28 Changing the display type ........................................ 28 Setting user display .................................................. 29 Setting the sound ..................................................... 29 Setting the screen display ........................................ 30 Simple picture-taking method ................................... 31 Tips for getting a clearer photo.................................. 32 Holding your camera correctly .................................. 32 Image stabilization .................................................... 32 Half-pressing the shutter button ............................... 32 Getting your subject in focus .................................... 33 Setting the automatic/manual focus function ............ 34 Zooming ................................................................... 34 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) ............................... 35 Using the OIS in the menu option ............................ 36 Depth preview .......................................................... 37 Basic shooting .....................................................38 Using the Smart Auto mode ...................................... 39 Using the Program mode .......................................... 40 Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode ........................................................ 41 Using the Aperture Priority mode .............................. 41 Aperture value .......................................................... 41 Using the Shutter Priority mode ................................ 42 Shutter speed ........................................................... 42 Using the Manual mode ........................................... 43 Using the Night/Portrait/Landscape mode ................ 45 Using the night mode ............................................... 45 Using the portrait mode ............................................ 45 Using the landscape mode ....................................... 45 Using the Scene mode .............................................. 46 Using the Beauty Shot mode ....................................... 47 Recording a Movie .................................................... 48 Setting the aperture value ......................................... 48 To fade out the screen ............................................. 48 Using the Wind Cut .................................................. 4910 Contents Extended shooting functions ...............................50 Setting the resolution and quality .............................. 51 Setting a resolution ................................................... 51 Setting the image quality of the picture ..................... 52 Setting the quality of movie....................................... 52 Noise reduction ........................................................ 53 Using the timer function ............................................ 54 Setting the timer function .......................................... 54 Taking a picture in a dark place ................................. 55 Using the flash popup button ................................... 55 Setting the flash option ............................................. 55 Using the red-eye fix function ................................... 56 1st Curtain, 2nd Curtain ........................................... 56 Adjusting the amount of flash light ............................ 57 Using an external flash unit (purchased separately) .. 58 Adjusting the ISO sensitivity ...................................... 59 Focusing methods .................................................... 60 Changing the Focusing methods .............................. 60 AF Priority ................................................................. 60 Using the AF assist light ........................................... 61 Changing the focus area .......................................... 61 Setting the focus of the selected area ...................... 62 Setting the MF Assist................................................ 63 Face detection .......................................................... 64 Normal face detection .............................................. 64 Self-portrait face detection ....................................... 65 Brightness and color adjustment of picture ............... 66 Adjusting the exposure (brightness) .......................... 66 Exposure adjustment................................................ 66 Changing the brightness measurement method ....... 67 Setting the white balance ......................................... 68 Color space .............................................................. 71 Smart range ............................................................. 72 Changing the shooting method ................................. 73 Successive shooting method and timer setup .......... 73 Detailed bracket setup ............................................. 74 Special effect/photo retouching ................................ 75 Picture wizard ........................................................... 75 Key Mapping ............................................................. 77 Setting the Key Mapping .......................................... 7711 Contents Playback/Editing ..................................................78 Play (picture/movie) ................................................... 79 Viewing pictures in the play mode ............................ 79 View files in the smart album by category ................. 81 Converting into the thumbnail view ........................... 81 File protection ........................................................... 82 Deleting a file ............................................................ 82 Enlargement/reduction ............................................. 84 View a movie ............................................................ 85 Picture editing ........................................................... 87 Changing the resolution ............................................ 87 Rotating .................................................................... 87 Red-eye fix ............................................................... 88 Adjusting the backlight ............................................. 88 Picture style .............................................................. 88 Face retouching........................................................ 88 Setting the print info (DPOF) ..................................... 89 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV ................................... 91 Transferring files to your computer ............................ 93 For Windows users ................................................... 93 For Mac users .......................................................... 96 Using Intelli-studio .................................................... 97 Transferring files using Intelli-studio .......................... 98 Using the Samsung RAW Converter ......................... 99 Correcting the exposure ......................................... 100 Handling the JPEG/TIFF files as you edit RAW files ... 101 Saving the RAW files into JPEG or TIFF format ...... 101 Printing photos with a photo printer (PictBridge) ..... 102 Camera settings menu .......................................103 Camera settings menu ............................................ 104 Sound .................................................................... 105 Display.................................................................... 105 Normal setup 1 ....................................................... 106 Normal setup 2 ....................................................... 107 Normal setup 3 ....................................................... 108 Appendixes ........................................................109 Error messages ....................................................... 110 Camera maintenance .............................................. 111 Cleaning your camera............................................. 111 About memory cards .............................................. 112 About the battery.................................................... 113 Before contacting a service center .......................... 115 Camera specifications ............................................. 118 Lens specifications .................................................. 122 Accessories (optional items) .................................... 123 Index ....................................................................... 125 Basic functions Learn about your camera’s layout, icons, and basic functions for shooting. Unpacking …………………………………………………13 Title and role of each part ………………………………14 Preparations before shooting ……………………………18 Turning on the power and initialization …………………23 Option/menu selection method …………………………26 Setting the display and sound ……………………………28 Simple picture-taking method ……………………………31 Tips for getting a clearer photo …………………………3213 Unpacking Check your product box for the following items. Camera (Body cap, eye-cup, Hot-shoe cover included) USB cable Battery Strap Software installation CD (including user's manual) Quick Start Manual Charger/AC power cable The actual components or optional parts may differ from the illustrations above. For information about optional items, see “Accessories (optional items).” (p. 123)14 Title and role of each part Mode dial (p. 5) AF-assist light /timer lamp (p. 61) Power switch (p. 23) Lens mount index (p. 21) Hot-shoe cover (p. 58) Strap holder (p. 22) Built-in flash (p. 55) Dial (p. 26) Shutter button (p. 7) Lens removal Lens mount (p. 21) button (p. 21) Flash button (p. 55) Depth preview button (p. 37) Hot-shoe (p. 58) Green button* Drive mode button (p. 73) Diopter adjustment dial (p. 16) * Use the green button [ ]. The following setup values are initialized if the button is pushed once in the standby state for shooting. Program shift / Detailed setup of picture wizard / Fine tuning of white balance / Color Temp. setting value / Adjusting the colors of screen menu / Timer / Flash EV / When selecting or setting AF, shift the changed focus area to the center / Bracketing setup Body cap (p. 21) DC-IN port HDMI port (p. 92) Shutter release connection port USB/AV OUT Port (p. 94) Image Sensor15 Title and role of each part AEL button (p. 77) EV button (p. 43) Eye-cup (p. 16) Display Viewfinder Eye sensor* DISP button (p. 28) Function(Fn) button (p. 27) Direction key (p. 5) Delete/Picture wizard button (p. 82) Battery chamber cover (p. 19) Playback button (p. 79) Tripod mount * Use of eye sensor This product will automatically convert to EVF when the users try to use the view-finder (EVF) by operating the eye sensor in Auto Select mode and all the information will be shown on the viewfinder. Do not cover the eye sensor with your hands or materials. Memory card slot Status lamp (p. 16) Memory card cover MENU button (p. 26)16 Title and role of each part Diopter adjustment dial/Eye-cup/ Status lamp Use of Diopter adjustment dial It is possible to adjust the viewfinder appropriate for the eyesight of user. If the image is not shown clearly through the viewfinder, move the eyesight adjustment dial in the left/right direction to have a clear view. Eye-cup Removal of Eye-cup When the camera is shipped, the eyecup is attached to the viewfinder. Push the Eye-cup up as shown in the figure for removal. Eyesight adjustment dial Status lamp In the case of saving a picture or shooting a movie, this shows the operating status of the camera by blinking the status indicator lamp • Blinking: When saving photos, recording movies, being read by a computer or printer. • Steady: When there is no data transfer or when connecting to a computer or printer is complete. Status lamp17 Title and role of each part Description for each part of the lens When purchasing the lens separately, please contact a Samsung service center to verify the compatibility of the camera an lens. This information in this user manual is based on the SAMSUNG 18-55mm F3.5-5.6 OIS lens. Please refer to the lens user manual for more information about the lens. • • Lens contacts Lens hood mount Zoom ring Lens mount connecting point OIS switch (p. 35) AF/MF switch (p. 34) Focus ring (p. 33) Lens [SAMSUNG 18-55mm F3.5-5.6 OIS] [SAMSUNG 30mm F2] Focus ring Lens Lens mount connecting point18 Preparations before shooting Charging the battery Please charge the battery fully before using this product. Please make the connections as in the following figure. Color of charge lamp Charging status Red Charging Green Fully charged Turned off, or Yellow Charging error To remove the battery from the charger, lift slightly in the direction of the arrow. Please use designated charger or batteries for proper use. SAMSUNG is not responsible for any accident that may occur from using a product other than designated. • • INSERT 1 2 INSERT CHARGE AC power code INSERT Charging lamp Charger19 Preparations before shooting Installing the battery When taking out the battery, pull down slightly on the lock lever. You can then remove the battery. 2 Lock lever 1 Open by pushing in the direction of the arrow 3 Close by pushing down in the direction of the arrow.20 Preparations before shooting Installing the memory card To remove the memory card, push the card slightly in the direction of insertion. Please do not remove the memory card or battery while the status indicator lamp is blinking. It may cause loss of data of product damage. • • 1 3 2 After checking the direction of metal terminal, you can insert the memory card.21 Preparations before shooting Mounting/dismounting the lens Please remove the lens mount cover and body cap prior to the installation of lens. After matching the lens mount index (red) of camera body with the point (red) of lens mount, join the lens by turning the lens clockwise until it clicks. When removing the lens, turn the lens counter clockwise while holding down the lens dismount button. Before mounting the lens Lens mounting Dismounting the lens Mounting or dismounting the lens while the camera is powered off is desirable to ensure the stable operation of the lens. SAMSUNG is not responsible for any accident, damage, or trouble caused by using other company's lens. The body cap protects the product from scratches or dust when you transport it. • • • Change lenses in a clean, low dust environment. Foreign particles inside the body or lens of the camera can cause the camera to malfunction. When mounting the lens, please do not touch the inner part of the camera with your finger. Dust or foreign particles inside the camera can affect image quality or cause the camera to malfunction. • • Lens mount connecting point22 Preparations before shooting Connecting the strap Connecting the strap to the camera body so you can carry the camera easily.23 Turning on the power and initialization When turning the power on/off, please set the power switch to ON/OFF. When you turn on the camera for the fi rst time, the camera may ask you to set the language and date. 1 Press [T] to select Language, and then press [ ]. 2 Press [S/T/W/X] to select a language, and then press [ ]. • The screen appears in the language you selected. 3 Press [S/T] to select Date, and then press [ ]. 4 Press [S/T/W/X] to set the date, and then press [ ]. MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time Exit Change Exit Change Exit Change24 5 Press [T] to select Time Zone and then press [ ]. 6 Select a desired world time zone by pressing [W/X]. 7 To set daylight saving time, press [S]. Press [S] again to disable. 8 Press [ ] to save. 9 Press [T] to select Time, and then press [ ]. 10 Set desired time by pressing [S/T/W/X], and then press [ ]. 11 Press [MENU] to finish setting. MENU OK 2 Date Time Zone Time Language 2010 1 1 00 : 00 English Date & Time Exit Change MENU 2 Time Zone London [GMT +00:00] 2010/01/01 01:10 AM Back DST Turning on the power and initialization25 Turning on the power and initialization A Information display Shooting mode Movie shooting mode Focus checking Flash 15 Shutter speed F3.5 Aperture value 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 Adjusted value of exposure AEL/AFL setting 0001 Possible no. of shots Battery information Displays no-insertion of memory card Warning of camera shake 12:00AM 2010.01.01 Time, date and year info Focus indicator ମGGଯ Spot metering area AF zone Histogram Grid display B Shooting option display(left) 14M Size Movie size SF Image quality Movie quality Focus area Flash Flash light adjustment RGB Color space Smart range OIS OIS Voice recording Fader Wind Cut C Shooting option display(right) Drive mode Timer AF mode White balance White balance adjustment ISO ISO Metering option Picture wizard The display shows the icons for the currently selected option. 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 15 F3.5 0001 A C AEL AFL 12:00AM 2010.01.01 14M SF RGB ISO B 3 - + 2 1 1 0 2 3 15 F3.5 0001 AAEEELL AFFFLL 12:00 12:0000 AMAM 2010.01.01 2010.01.01 OIS Icons All the details shown on the view finder will appear identically on the display. By using the live view function, the user can take a picture conveniently without having to look through the viewfinder. The icons shown on the screen are for when the OIS and AF/MF switches on the lens are in use.26 1 Press [MENU] in the Shooting mode. 2 You can select a desired option or menu by pressing [S/T/W/X] or [ ]. 3 To save a selected option or menu, press [ ]. Return to the previous screen To return to the previous menu screen, press [MENU]. Using the dial The user may change the menu setting's value by either using the dial or move the menu screen to a desired direction. For example when taking a picture in the shutter speed priority mode, this allows you to quickly adjust the desired shutter speed. Example. Using the dial in the S mode 1 Set the Mode dial to S. 2 Adjust the shutter speed by turning the dial. • The camera sets aperture value automatically according to the shutter speed you set. Option/menu selection method After pressing [MENU], you can select an option or menu by pressing [S/T] or [ ]. The user can return to the state of shooting by pressing [Shutter]. AF MF WB ISO AF/MF setting, Menu navigation (S) ISO setting, Menu navigation (T) White balance setting, Menu navigation (X) Metering method setting, Menu navigation (W) OK button, Setting Selection AF27 Using [Fn] By pressing the [Fn] function button, you can easily access major functions such as Quality, Size, AF area, Flash, Color Space, Smart Range, and OIS. Example. Flash setting in the P mode 1 Set the Mode dial to P. 2 Press the [Fn] button on the body of camera. 3 Select Flash using the [W/X] or dial. 4 Press [S]. 5 Set the flash menu option using the [W/X] or dial. 6 Press [S]. 7 Set the flash intensity using the [W/X] or dial. • You can adjust the intensity of the flash by ±2 levels. 8 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 9 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Option/menu selection method Displays the level of flash intensity adjustment Flash 14M SF RGB OIS Fill in 14M SF RGB OIS28 Setting the display and sound Learn how to change basic display and sound settings according to your preferences. Changing the display type You can select the icons and options the camera displays in the Shooting and Play modes by selecting a Display Type. Press [DISP] repeatedly. Shooting mode Display all the shooting information except for User Display setting values. Display all the shooting modes set by user. (p. 29) Hide all the information except for shooting mode, shutter speed, aperture value, exposure, number of available shots, and battery information. • • • Playback mode Display the shooting meta information. Display the RGB histogram, currently selected histogram option, and date set. Display shutter speed, aperture value, ISO, file in play, and total number of files saved. • • • Viewing the function descriptions of menu 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select a menu option. • Press and hold [DISP]. The function descriptions of the menu appears on the screen. ? Resolution and H/V ratio of images can be set. Photo Size DISP AF - MF WB ISO DISP button 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 14M SF RGB ISO 20 F3.7 0001 09:45 2010.01.01 OIS29 Setting the display and sound Setting user display You can add or remove shooting information from the display. 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting mode. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → User Display → an option. About histogram A histogram is a graph that shows the brightness distribution of picture. This represents a dark picture if the graph is inclined to the left and if the graph is leaning to the right, this represents a bright picture. The height of graph is related to the color information and the graph gets higher if a specific color is distributed more. ▲Insufficient exposure ▲Balanced exposure ▲Excessive exposure Setting the sound You can set the sound the camera makes when you press the OK button. 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Setting2( 2) → Sound → System Volume → an option. Off The camera makes no sound when you press [ ]. Low, Medium, High The camera makes a signal sound when you press [ ]. 3 Press [MENU] to return to the previous mode. 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 14M RGB 20 F3.7 0001 09:45 2010.01.01 Icon 09:45 009:45 5 2010.01.01 2010 01 010.01.0101 SF 3 - + 2 1 1 0 2 3 20 F3.7 0001 14M RGB SFF Histogram Grid Icon ISO OIS30 Setting the screen display The screen display can be set according to the user’s convenience. 1 In Shooting or Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Setting3 ( 3) → Display Select 3 Select a desired option. Auto Select Convert between Main Display and EVF by eye sensor Main Display The screen will be shown only through Main Display EVF The screen will be shown only through EVF MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 Display Select Video Out Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC) HDMI Size Firmware Update Auto NTSC On Auto 3 Auto Select Main Display EVF Back Set Setting the display and sound31 1 Rotate the mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame. All the details shown on the view finder will appear identically on the display. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Simple picture-taking method Using the Smart Auto mode, you can take a picture easily with minimum setup. • Please refer to the "Tips for getting a clearer photo" (p. 32) to take a clear picture. • Press [ ] to see the saved images on the screen. ● Green: Focus is set. ● Red: Focus is not set. 14M RGB WHITE 0001 OIS 14M SMART RGB WHITE 0001 OIS32 Holding your camera correctly Please make sure that your hand, hair, and strap do not interfere with the lens or flash. Image stabilization Half-pressing the shutter button In order to check in advance whether the focus of composition is set appropriately, please use the half-shutter function. If you press the shutter halfway down, the focus and exposure will be adjusted automatically. In order to check in advance whether the focus of composition is set appropriately, please use the half-shutter function. If you press the shutter halfway down, the focus and exposure will be adjusted automatically. Tips for getting a clearer photo Shows the shutter speed and aperture value being set. Focus frame If green, take the picture by pressing the [Shutter]. If red, either change the composition or adjust the focus again since the focus is not correctly set. • • To avoid the blurring effect of camera shake, set the optical Image Stabilization (OIS) function. (p.35) • 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 14M SF RGB ISO 125 F3.5 0001 OIS33 Under the following circumstances, it may be difficult to get your subject in focus: When the color contrast is not clear (When someone is wearing clothes similar in color to the background) When the subject is in front of a strong backlight When the subject generates strong reflected light When there is a horizontally repeated line pattern (window blinds, etc.) When the subject is not located in the center When there is a flat white wall behind the subject which does not have specific patterns. When there is a fast moving subject. When the subject is too close to the camera. • • • • • • • • Using the manual focus If the auto focus function does not operate normally due to the environmental factors, your can set the lens to Manual Focus (MF) and adjust the focus manually. When the lens’ focus method is set to Manual Focus (MF), this function helps focus the subject by expanding the screen automatically. If the focus is adjusted by using the expanded image, the focus can be adjusted more accurately.(p. 63) Getting your subject in focus Please try to use the focus lock function. Adjust the focus by using the half-shutter function where the camera can focus easily. Then, simply press the [Shutter] button after moving the camera to a desired composition. Keep pressing and holding down the half-shutter until you actually make a photo shot. Under the half-shutter state, press the [AEL] button of the camera to fix the exposure value and focus information at the same time according to the setting. To cancel the function, press the [AEL] button once more. (p. 77) • Use the [AF/MF] control switch on the lens to switch the camera to manual focus. • If the lens doesn't have an AF/MF switch, you may be able to select Manual Focus in the AF mode menu • The availability of this option differs, depending on the lens you are using. • When you adjust the focus manually, the picture may appear blurred if you don't set the focus accurately. Take pictures after setting the focus accurately. • When using the manual focus function, the AF Area is not available to use. • In the movie shooting mode, you can not set the focus by using the expanded image.34 Setting the automatic/manual focus function You can set the camera to adjust focus automatically or manually by using the AF/MF switch on the side of the lens. 1 Using automatic focus Set the AF/MF switch of the lens to AF. The focus adjusts automatically when you press the shutter button half way down. 2 Using manual focus Set the AF/MF switch of the lens to MF. You can adjust the focus manually by turning the focus ring. Zooming Using the zoom ring, you can enlarge (telephoto angle) or reduce (wide angle) the size of an image by changing the focal length value of the camera lens. Adjust the image to the desired size, and then take a picture. 1 Check the focus, and then turn the zoom ring to the left/right. The focal length of the lens changes and the subject appears enlarged or reduced. 2 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Since the focus can change slightly when you zoom in or out, we recommend you adjust the focus again prior to taking a picture. Some lens models do not have the AF/MF switch. Please consider this when purchasing a lens. (p.60)35 Optical Image Stabilization (OIS) Use the optical image stabilization (OIS) function when taking pictures to minimize camera shake and improve focus. ▲ Before applying OIS ▲ After applying OIS Using the OIS switch of lens The OIS function can be used only in the case that the lens in use has the OIS function. To use this function, please set [OIS] to ON. ON OIS OFF36 Using the OIS in the menu option After setting the OIS switch, select the OIS function in the menu option 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting3 ( 3/ 3) → OIS → an option. OIS Mode 1 The OIS function is applied only when pressing the shutter in full or half. OIS Mode 2 The OIS function is always applied. The OIS function may not work well in the following situations: When you take a picture while tracing a moving object When a big vibration occurs beyond the range of stabilization When the shutter speed is too slow due to a circumstance like night shooting When the battery capacity is not sufficient When you are shooting a close-up shot When you use a tripod, please disable the OIS function since the image can be shaken due to the vibration of OIS function. If the camera is struck or dropped while you are taking a picture, the display can be impaired. If this occurs, turn the camera off and then on, and the camera should operate normally again. Since the battery consumption can increase along with the use of OIS function, it is recommended to use the function only if needed. To set the OIS function by using the menu, set [OIS] of lens to ON. This function may not operate depending on the lens model. The function can be set directly by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode. • - - - - - • • • • •37 Depth preview When you are not using the depth preview function, you can only see the subject through the camera in the condition of the maximum aperture (minimum f-number) in the shooting mode. Use the Depth of Field Preview function before taking a picture to view the depth of field of the scene as it looks with the lens set to its current f-stop number. 1 Press the [Depth Preview] in the Shooting mode. 2 You can check the depth of field result actually taken through the display and viewfinder. What is the depth of field? When you focus on a specific subject, there is a range in which objects closer and further away are all in focus. This focused range is called the depth of field. The wider the wide-angle lens, the higher the aperture value, the greater the depth of field. For example, the aperture stop, f 11 is higher than f 2.8. Current position of the subject Current position of the subject 10 meters 6 meters 4 meters 2 meters 1 meters 10 meters 6 meters 4 meters 2 meters 1 meters S This refer to an appropriate range of focus when the depth of field is deep. S This refer to an appropriate range of focus when the depth of field is shallow. You can set the function of a button differently by using the Key Mapping menu option. (p. 77) Depth preview buttonBasic shooting Learn how to take a photo by selecting a mode and how to record a video. Using the Smart Auto mode ………………………… 39 Using the Program mode …………………………… 40 Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode ……………………………………… 41 Using the Night/Portrait/Landscapee mode ……… 45 Using the Scene mode ……………………………… 46 Recording a Movie …………………………………… 4839 Using the Smart Auto mode The smart auto mode allows taking pictures under an optimized condition since the camera recognizes various photographing conditions automatically. Therefore, even a beginner can use the camera easily. 1 Rotate the mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame. • The camera automatically detects the type of scene and displays the corresponding scene icon in the display. Outdoor landscape shot Highly bright background shot Night landscape shot Outdoor portrait shot at night Backlight landscape shot without a man Portrait shot under backlight Portrait shot Close-up shot Close-up character shot Sunset shot Blue sky shot Nature shot such as forest and leaves Close-up shot for the subject with various colors Close-up portrait shot With the camera on a tripod, a shot of a subject that does not move for a period of time. Shot of fast moving subject or subject that moves frequently. 3 Half-press [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. If the camera does not detect a type of scene, it takes pictures with the basic settings of the mode. . Even if it detcts a face, the camera may not select portrait mode because of the orientation and brightness of the face. The camera may not recognize a scene because of adverse photograph conditions such as bad lighting, camera shake, and subject distance. The camera may not recognize the mode, even it the camera is on a tripod, depending on the movement of the subject. • • • • The camera displays the scene icon corresponding to the scene it detects. 14M SMART RGB WHITE 14M 0001 OIS40 Using the Program mode In the program mode, the camera automatically adjusts the shutter speed and aperture value to maintain the correct exposure. 1 Rotate the mode dial to P. 2 Set options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 3 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. What is the program shift method? If this function is used, desired shutter speed and aperture value can be selected while maintaining the same brightness. The shutter speed and aperture value are changed as in the following rules. The available aperture numbers for exposure setting is different depending on the lens model. Dial direction Changing the exposure value Left Decreased shutter speed + increased aperture Right Increased shutter speed + decreased aperture 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 14M SF RGB ISO 15 F3.5 0001 OIS41 Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode By using the aperture value of adjusting light volume and shutter speed, you can take pictures of desired exposure. As for the shooting modes that allows adjusting the aperture value and shutter speed, there are the aperture priority mode, shutter speed priority mode, and manual mode. Using the Aperture Priority mode The Aperture Priority mode lets you to set the aperture value manually while the camera automatically selects an appropriate shutter speed. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to A. 2 Rotate the dial to adjust the aperture value. 3 Set options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 4 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 5 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Aperture value The aperture value of a lens can be adjusted to control the amount of light reaching the image sensor. When opening the aperture (reduce the aperture value), objects closer and further away than the focused subject will be out of focus. When closing the aperture (increase the aperture value), the range in focus expands forward and backward. ▲ Increased aperture value (narrower opening) ▲ Reduced aperture value (wider opening) 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 14M 20 F3.5 0001 SF RGB ISO A OIS F442 Using the Shutter Priority mode The Shutter Priority mode lets you set the shutter speed manually while the camera automatically selects an appropriate aperture value. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to S. 2 Rotate the dial to adjust the shutter speed. 3 Set options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 4 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 5 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Shutter speed Shutter speed is the length of time the shutter is open. You can creat many interesting effects by adjusting the shutter speed. A low shutter speed blurs motion on the image. You can feel the speed in the picture when the low shutter speed is used for a shot. A fast shutter speed is essential for capturing the movement. A faster shutter speed froze the subject in its movement. ▲ Slow shutter speed ▲ Fast shutter speed Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 14M SF RGB ISO S 250 F3.7 0001 OIS43 Using the Manual mode In the manual mode, you can take pictures by setting various shot options directly including the shutter speed and aperture value. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to M. 2 Rotate the dial to adjust the shutter speed. 3 Rotate the dial to adjust the aperture value while press and hold the [EV]. 4 Set desired shooting options. • For a list of options, refer to “Extended shooting functions.”(p. 50) 5 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 6 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode EV button Dial In the P (Program), S (Shutter Priority), or A (Aperture Priority) modes, when a value appears in red, it is outside the range of values that produces good pictures. P mode: Shutter speed and aperture value can appear in red. S mode: Shutter speed can appear in red. A mode: Aperture value can appear in red. The camera can not set the ISO speed automatically in the M (manual) mode. • •44 Using the bulb exposure By using the bulb exposure, you can set the shutter speed as long as you want. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to M. 2 Rotate the dial and set the shutter speed to Bulb. • Bulb exposure indication appears next to the shutter speed of 30"(seconds). 3 To adjust the aperture value, press and hold the [EV] while rotating the dial. 4 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 5 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. • The exposure time continues until you finish holding the [Shutter]. Press and hold the [Shutter] for desired time. As soon as you finish holding the [Shutter], the shooting is complete. Using the Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or Manual mode To improve image stability in the Bulb Exposure mode, we recommend you use a reliable tripod or shutter release (purchased separately). With long exposures, the time the camera takes to save images gets longer as well. This is not a problem with the product and you do not need to replace the battery. Before using Bulb Exposure to take long exposures, we recommend you fully charging the battery. When you use Bulb Exposure to take long exposures, visual noise can occur. To control visual noise, we recommend you turn the Noise Reduction function on. The Noise Reduction function operates when the shutter exposure exceeds 1 seconds. When you use Bulb Exposure, the Successive Shooting function is unavailable. When you use Bulb Exposure, you can not set the ISO Speed to AUTO. • • • • • • 14M SF RGB ISO Bulb F3.5 00'00'' 0173 OIS45 Using the night mode Night mode provides the optimal exposure settings for dark or night time environments. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the portrait mode In Portrait mode, the camera automatically sets optimal portrait shot settings. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the landscape mode Landscape mode provides the optimal exposure and focus settings for natural landscapes. 1 Rotate the mode dial to . 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Using the Night/Portrait/Landscape mode When you use Night mode, we recommended you also use a tripod, shutter release, or Timer function (purchased separately) to minimize camera shake. In the portrait mode, the focus area is automatically set to the face as it is set to the Face Detection AF mode automatically. In the landscape mode, the camera adjusts shutter speed automatically according to the aperture value. We recommend you use a tripod in case the camera selects a slow shutter speed setting.46 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Select a scene. x Press [MENU] to select a scene. You can select a desired scene. x For the Beauty Shot mode, see “Using the Beauty Shot mode.” 3 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 4 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. If you have the camera set to Standby mode and the Mode dial set to , you can directly select a desired scene by pressing [Fn]. Using the Scene mode Since an appropriate option is set in advance by the scene, the shot can be taken conveniently by selecting a scene appropriate for the situation. MENU OK 1 Beauty Shot Back Set47 Using the Beauty Shot mode In the beauty shot mode, you can take pictures with options that make faces appear smooth and blemishfree. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → SCENE → Beauty Shot. 4 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Face Tone. 5 Set options. x Select a higher setting to make skin tone appear lighter. 6 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Face Retouch. 7 Set options. x Select a higher setting to make skin tone appear lighter. 8 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 9 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. MENU OK 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Face Tone Face Retouch OIS Level 1 In the Beauty Shot mode, AF area is set to Face Detection AF or Self-Portrait AF. Using the Scene mode MENU OK 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 Face Tone Face Retouch OIS Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Back Set Back Set Level 1 Level 2 Level 348 Recording a Movie In the movie shooting mode, you can shoot videos in High Definition quality (1280x720). You can continue recording movies up to 25 minutes. The recorded video is saved as an H.264 (MPEG-4.AVC) file. 1 Rotate the Mode dial to . 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Quality. 4 Set options. 5 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Voice. 6 Select whether to record sound. 7 Press [Shutter] to start recording. 8 Press [Shutter] again to stop recording. Setting the aperture value You can set the aperture value when shooting a movie. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Movie AE Mode → an option. P Program The aperture value is adjusted automatically. A Aperture Priority Set the aperture value by using the dial before taking the movie. To fade out the screen You can make the movie screen darker or brighter gradually in recording by using the fader function. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Fader. Off Fader function not used In Scene gradually fades in when recording starts. Out Scene gradually fades out when recording ends In-Out The fader function is applied at the start and end of the scene Movie frame speed is fixed at 30 fps (30 frames/sec). While shooting a movie, push the [Depth Preview] button once to activate the AF function and once again to cancel the function. This function may not work depending on the lens you are using. • • REC WWaWX 01:00 3 - + 2 23 1 1 0 F3.5 01:0049 Recording a Movie Using the Wind Cut Use the wind noise removal function to remove some surrounding noise in addition to the wind noise. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting3 ( 3) → Wind Cut → an option. Pause while recording a movie By using the pause function, you can shoot only desired scenes into one file without generating several movie files. To pause during the recording, press [ ]. • To continue on recording, press [ ] again. H.264 (MPEG-4 part10/AVC) is the latest video coding format established in 2003 collaboratively by ISO-IEC and ITU-T. Since this format uses a high compression rate, more data can be saved in less memory space. When using a slow writing memory card, your movie's recording can be interrupted because the card can not process data at the rate the video is being shot. If this occurs, replace the card with a faster memory card or reduce the image size. If you have the image stabilizer option on when shooting a movie, the camera may record the image stabilizer sound. When the size of a movie file exceeds 4GB, the camera automatically stops recording. If this occurs, continue the movie by starting a new movie file. When formatting a memory card, always format using this camera. If you format on another camera or a PC, you can cause a change in the capacity of the card or make it incompatible with your camera. If you remove the camera lens while recording a movie, the recording will be interrupted. Do not change the lens while recording. While you shoot a movie, the camera can record the sounds of the zoom mechanism working and the sounds the camera makes when you press the buttons. If you change the shooting angle of the camera suddenly while shooting a movie, the camera may not be able to record images accurately. We recommend using a tripod when shooting a movie. In this way, you can minimize camera shake. In the Movie Shooting mode, the camera supports only the Multi AF function. You can not use any other focus area setting functions, such as Face Detection AF. • • • • • • • • • When you use the Fader function, it may takes longer to save images. •Extended shooting functions Learn about the options you can set in shooting mode. By using the shooting options, you can enjoy more customized pictures and movies. Setting the resolution and quality …………………… 51 Using the timer function ……………………………… 54 Taking a picture in the dark place …………………… 55 Focusing methods …………………………………… 60 Face detection ………………………………………… 64 Brightness and color adjustment of picture ………… 66 Changing the shooting method ……………………… 73 Special effect/photo retouching ……………………… 75 Key Mapping …………………………………………… 77 51 Setting a resolution To capture the high level of detail and excellent image quality in your picture or video, it is a good idea to set the resolution to the highest setting. The main drawback is that the file size becomes relatively big. Setting picture resolution 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Photo Size → an option. Picture size (display ratio) Proper use 14M 4592 x 3056 (3:2) For printing photos on A1 size prints. 10M 3872 x 2592 (3:2) For printing photos on A2 size prints. 6M 3008 x 2000 (3:2) For printing photos on A3 size prints. 2M 1920 x 1280 (3:2) For printing photos on A5 size prints. 4592 x 2584 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A1 size prints. 3872 x 2176 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A3 size prints. 3008 x 1688 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A4 size prints. 1920 x 1080 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV (16:9) or printing A5 size prints. Setting video resolution 1 Press [MENU] in the Video Shooting mode. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Movie Size → an option. 1280 (16:9) When outputting to HDTV 640 640 (4:3) When outputting to normal TV 320 320 (4:3) When uploading and using on the web Setting the resolution and quality You can also set the Resolution function by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode.52 Setting the image quality of a picture The camera saves pictures in either in the JPEG or RAW format. The compression ratio is reduced as the image quality gets better. It is necessary to increase the file size to have a better quality picture. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Quality → an option. SF Super Fine Set to super fine quality F Fine Set to fine quality N Normal Set to normal quality RAW RAW Save in the RAW file format RAW S.FINE S.Fine+RAW Save super-fine image and RAW file at the same time RAW FINE Fine+RAW Save fine image and RAW file at the same time RAW NORMAL Normal+RAW Save normal image and RAW file at the same time Setting the quality of a movie The camera saves movies in normal or high quality. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting1 ( 1) → Quality → an option. Normal Set normal quality HQ Set high quality • The camera saves RAW fi le format images without data loss and only in the 14M (4592 x 3056) photo size. Although settings for white balance, contrast, saturation, and sharpness, etc. are not reflected in the image, they are saved as information. If you want to save the RAW data into an image fi le format such as JPEG or TIFF, use the provided software (SAMSUNG RAW Converter). RAW fi les have an "SRW" extension. (For example: “SAM_9999.SRW”) Setting the resolution and quality You can also set the Quality function by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode.53 Noise reduction This function can be set to reduce the noise in pictures. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → Noise Reduction → an option. High ISO NR This function reduces noise that may occur when you set a highspeed ISO (3200). Long Term NR This function reduces noise when you set the camera for a long exposure (over 1 seconds). It requires additional processing time equal to the shutter speed you used to take the picture. Setting the resolution and quality When the Noise reduction function is disabled, there might be a noise in the recorded picture.54 Setting the timer function 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → Drive. 3 Press [Fn] after selecting Timer. 4 Select the operation time by rotating the dial or pressing [W / X]. • You can select the timer setting from 2 ~ 30 seconds. 5 The shot is taken automatically after the time being set has passed by pressing [Shutter]. Using the timer function The function can be set directly by pressing [ ] in the shooting mode. To cancel the self timer function, press [ ] one more time, or press [Shutter]. MENU 2 Timer Back Reset55 Using the flash popup button The flash operates when you pop-up the built-in flash by pressing the flash button. When the flash is closed, it will not burst out the light and the , , , and modes support automatic popup and flash light. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [ ]. 2 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 3 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. • Even if you have opened the flash using the 'Flash' button, the flash will not work if you have the Flash Option in the menu set to Off. Setting the flash option If a picture is taken in a dark place, the picture may appear to be dark since the light source is not sufficient. Press [ ] to pop up the flash. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) →Flash→ an option. Off The flash light doesn't operate. SMART Smart Flash The camera automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash according to the amount of light in the surrounding environment. Auto The flash light operates automatically in the dark place. Auto+Red The flash light operates automatically and prevents the red-eye effect. Fill in • The flash operates whenever you take a picture. • The brightness of the flash is automatically controlled. Fill-in Red The flash operates whenever you take a picture and prevents the red-eye effect. 1st Curtain The flash operates immediately after the shutter opens. 2nd Curtain The flash operates just before the shutter closes. • You can take a better picture if the subject is located within the operational range of the flash. (Refer to the Guide Number in “Specification,”) • You can set the auto flash option for external flashes on the NX-series models only. • The flash options available differ, depending on the shooting modes. Flash button Taking a picture in a dark place The function can be set directly by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode.56 Using the red-eye fix function When you take a portrait using the flash, the bright burst of light can cause the red-eye effect. To prevent the red eye effect, set the flash option to Auto+Red or Fill-in Red. 1st Curtain, 2nd Curtain The following images were obtained by taking the pictures of straight-moving subject along with the respective options of 1st Curtain and 2nd Curtain. In case of using the 1st Curtain flash function, the front part of action is remained clearly since the flash will burst light immediately upon shutter opening. Since the flash bursts the light at a later time when having used the 2nd Curtain option, the picture expresses the last image of the subject clearly. Ball moving direction Ball moving direction S Use of early 1st Curtain option S Use of 2nd Curtain option Taking a picture in a dark place • When you set the red-eye fix function, the camera prevents red-eye by emitting a preliminary flash prior to the brighter flash it emits when capturing the image. • When the subject is moving or is far away from the camera at the time of the preliminary flash, the function may not function well.57 Adjusting the amount of flash light When setting a fl ash option, you can adjust the brightness of the flash. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → Flash. 3 Press the [Fn] button after selecting a desired item. 4 Adjust the brightness of the fl ash by rotating the dial or pressing [W / X]. • You can adjust fl ash brightness by ±2 levels. Taking a picture in a dark place • If the subject is too close, the ISO sensitivity is high, or the exposure value is too large or small, the adjustment effect will be reduced. • The Flash Brightness Adjustment function is not available in some shooting modes. • If an external fl ash unit has a flash control function, the light control value of the external flash is applied when you connect it to the camera. • If the distance from the subject is quite close when taking images by using the built-in flash, part of the images may appear dark as the lens is interfered with the flash light. Please check the distance between camera and subject when taking pictures. The distance interfered with flash light may vary by the type of lens in use. • If you've installed a lens hood, the hood can block light from the built-in flash. Please remove the lens hood when using the built-in flash. MENU 1 Flash Exposure Value Back Reset Display the level of flash light adjustment 58 Using an external flash unit (purchased separately) You can use the A-TTL auto fl ash mode when you attach an external fl ash unit (SEF20A or SEF42A) to the camera. This section of the user manual was prepared based on the model SEF20A flash. For more details about the external fl ash units, see the flash units user’s manual. Installing the flash 1 Install the external fl ash after removing the hot shoe cover. 2 Turn on the external fl ash. • The burst mode of external flash is set to the TTL auto mode. 3 Make sure the external flash is fully charged, and then start shooting. The available flash modes The flash modes available are determined by the camera lens or camera exposure mode you are using. 1 Smart Flash Mode • The camera automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash according to amount of light in the surrounding environment. 2 Auto • The flash operates automatically in dim or dark light. 3 Auto + Red • The flash operates automatically in dim or dark light and prevents the red-eye effect. 4 Fill in • The flash operates whenever you take a picture and its brightness is controlled automatically. 5 Fill-in Red • Always operates the flash light, and prevents the red-eye effect. 6 1st Curtain • The flash operates immediately after the shutter opens. 7 2nd Curtain • The flash operates just before the shutter closes. Taking a picture in a dark place • Only a fl ash device manufactured for the NX series automatically adjusts the brightness of the flash. To enjoy the auto mode functions, please use the flash manufactured for NX models. Although the flash fires without the battery being fully charged, we recommend using the fl ash only after you charge the battery fully. • If an external flash unit has a flash control function, the light control value of the external flash is applied when you connect it to the camera.59 Adjusting the ISO sensitivity The ISO sensitivity, as the film sensitivity established by the international standards organization (ISO), represents the degree of reaction when camera receives light. Since it reacts more sensitively with greater ISO value, a natural shot can be obtained in a dark place by raising the ISO value. This reduces the degree of camera shaking with faster shutter speed. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → ISO → an option. Taking a picture in a dark place • The higher the ISO speed you select, the more visual noise you may get. • When the noise reduction function is used, the noise caused by the high-sensitive ISO(3200) can be reduced. • The available ISO setting options may differ depending on the Shooting mode. • You can set the ISO directly by pressing [ISO] in the Shooting mode.60 Focusing methods Changing the Focusing methods You can select a focusing method appropriate to the subject you are photographing. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2/ 2) → AF Mode → an option. Single AF When you press [shutter] half way down, the focus fixes in one position. Continuous AF When you hold the [shutter] half-way down, the focus adjusts continually as the subject changes position. Manual Focus Adjust the focus manually by turning the focus ring. AF Priority When you use the AF focusing function, the AF Priority function prevents the shutter from fi ring if the focus is not appropriately set. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Priority → an option. Off Camera takes a shot regardless of the focus. On The camera takes a shot only if the focus is set correctly when you press the shutter button. Even if the focus is set correctly when you press the shutter half way, the camera will not take the shot if the focus is not set correctly when you press the shutter button fully. • If your lens has an [AF/MF] switch, you can set the lens to MF and adjust the focus manually. • If there is no AF/MF switch on the lens, you can switch to manual focus by selecting Manual Focus in the AF mode menu. • The selectable option may differ according to the lens in use. • When adjusting the focus manually, the picture may appear blurred if you don't set the focus accurately. Please take a picture after setting the focus accurately. (p. 32). • You can also set the AF/MF function directly by pressing [ ] on top of the directional button while in Shooting mode. Even with AF Priority on, the Continuous and the Burst Shot options let the shutter fi re whether the focus is set correctly or not.61 Focusing methods Using the AF assist light The auto focus functions more accurately in dark places when the AF assist light is on. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → AF Lamp. Off AF assist light not used On AF assist light turns on when light is not sufficient. Changing the focus area The AF Area function changes the positions of the focus area or areas and can give you clearer, sharper pictures. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) →AF Area→ an option. Selection AF Sets the focus appropriately for an area you have selected. Multi AF Displays a green rectangle in all the Face places where focus is set correctly. Face Detection AF Shows the areas that the focus is correctly set in the display. SelfPortrait AF When the sound effect is heard at the time of self-shot, you can check the position of the subject’s face. • The available options may differ by Shooting mode. • When you set the AF/MF switch on the lens to MF, you can not change the AF area using the Shooting menu. • When you select the Multi AF function, the AF areas that are in focus appear in green. • You can select this function directly by pressing [Fn] in the Shooting mode. 62 Setting the focus of the selected area In the shooting composition, a shot may be taken by setting the focus to the area desired by user. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Area → Selection AF. 3 Press [MENU] to return to the previous mode. 4 In the Shooting mode, press [ ]. 5 Press [S/T/W/X] to move the focus area. 6 Adjust the size of focus area by using the dial. 7 Align your subject in the frame and halfpress [Shutter] to focus. 8 Press [Shutter] to take a photo. Focusing methods AF Zoom Move MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 AF Mode AF Area AF Priority MF Assist Drive Flash 3 Back Set Selection AF Multi AF Face Detection AF Self-Portrait AF AF Zoom Move63 Setting the MF Assist When the lens’ focus method is set to Manual Focus (MF), this function helps focus the subject by expending the screen automatically. 1 Set the focus method to Manual Focus. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → MF Assist 3 Select a desired option. Off Do not enlarge the subject on screen when it is in Manual focus mode. On Enlarge the subject on screen when you adjust the focus in Manual focus mode. MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 AF Mode AF Area AF Priority MF Assist Drive Flash 3 On Off On Back Set Focusing methods64 Face detection When you use the Face Detection AF function, you can set the focus around a person's face when taking a portrait shot. This function can also be useful when shooting a self-portrait. Normal face detection When you use the Face Detection AF option, the camera sets the auto focus based on the faces in the frame. When the shooting composition is set, the camera automatically detects as many as 10 faces and sets the focus and exposure. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Area → Face Detection AF. • Face detection may not be effective when. - The subject is too far away - The light is too bright or dark - The subject is not facing the camera - When part of the face is hidden by an object like sunglasses. - Part of the subject's face is hidden by sunglasses or similar objects - The subject makes a large facial expression - The light or backlight on the subject's face is not uniform • Depending on the Picture Wizard option, the camera may not recognize the subject’s face • The options available may differ depending on the shooting mode. • This function is not available if you have selected such options as Manual Focus and Selection AF. • The face detection function works faster when the camera is closer to the subject. • When you use the Face Detection AF option, the white focus area is automatically set to focus. The focus frame is shown by white for the closest face and by gray for the rest of faces. 65 Self-portrait face detection With Self-Portrait AF on, the camera chirps rapidly when your face is in focus. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → AF Area → Self-Portrait AF. 3 Press [Shutter] if having an info sound of shooting. Check the focus of the subject in Shooting mode Face detection66 Brightness and color adjustment of picture Adjusting the exposure (brightness) The images can be taken bright or dark according to the amount of light. In this case, appropriate adjustment can be made by controlling the amount of light entered into the lens. S Applying - S 0 S Applying + 1 Check the accurate focus of subject in the shooting mode 2 To adjust the exposure value, hold down the [ ] button, and then rotate the dial. • The adjustment value of exposure can be checked from the viewfinder and display. 3 Press the [Shutter] button to take a picture. Exposure adjustment You can set the size of the exposure adjustment. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → EV Step → an option. 1/3 Change the exposure level by 1/3 step. 1/2 Change the exposure level by 1/2 step. • When fixing and using the exposure value being set, it may be excessively bright or dark according to the shooting environment. Please take a picture by adjusting the exposure value appropriate for the shooting environment. • When it is difficult to judge an appropriate value of exposure, please set the detailed setting of AE BKT (successive shots of exposure increase/decrease). This takes 3 pictures successively, including one step darker one and one step brighter one (p. 73). • The camera displays the exposure warning in red for each step beyond the ±3 range. Standard exposure index Exposure level display Decreased exposure (Darker) Increased exposure (Brighter) 3 - + 2 2 1 1 0 3 Exposure warning 3 267 Changing the brightness measurement method If the composition of image is set, the camera measures the amount of light. At this time, the brightness and overall mood of the picture may vary depending on how the measurement is made. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 3 ( 3/ 3 ) → Metering → an option. Spot • Calculate the amount of light in the center. • This is suitable when taking a portrait shot where there is a strong backlight. • When the subject is not located in the center of the display, the subject can appear to be too bright or too dark. Centerweighted • This calculates the amount of light in the center portion of the shot and averages the result over the entire image. • This is suitable when the area of the subject is large when compared to the overall composition of the picture. Multi • Calculate the amount of light in multiple areas. • Suitable for normal pictures. Brightness and color adjustment of picture The function can be set directly by pressing [ ] in the shooting mode.68 Setting the white balance Different light sources will affect the resulting color of your picture. To take a picture with colors close to what is seen with our own eyes, please select the white balance appropriate for the light source or manually adjust the color temperature desired. In case of a light source that is difficult to take in to effect, the shot can be taken by adjusting the white balance manually according to the picture-taking situation. Auto Daylight Cloudy Incandescent bulb 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance → an option. Auto WB The camera automatically selects the optimal white balance settings. Daylight For shooting outdoors on a clear day. Cloudy For shooting outdoors on a cloudy day. Fluorescent White Daylight, fluorescent lamp, suitable especially for the white fluorescent light with the color temperature of about 4200K Fluorescent NW Daylight, fluorescent lamp, suitable especially for the daylight fluorescent lighting with the color temperature of about 5,000K Fluorescent Daylight Daylight, fluorescent lamp, suitable especially for the daylight-like fluorescent lighting with the color temperature of about 6,500K Tungsten For shooting under halogen lamps and standard, incandescent bulbs. Flash WB Suitable when using the built-in flash light Custom Set To create a custom white ballance setting. Color Temp. To set the color temperature manually. Brightness and color adjustment of picture The function can be set directly by pressing [WB] in the shooting mode.69 Fine adjustment of the white balance 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance. 3 Select a White Balance option, and then press [Fn]. 4 Adjust a desired white balance by using the dial or [S/T/W/X]. 5 Press [ ] to save. User setup method If the shot is taken after setting the composition of white paper, filled in full frame, an appropriate white balance value is set according to the measured light source. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance. 3 Select Custom Set, and then press [Fn]. 4 After setting the composition to show only the white paper, press [Shutter]. Brightness and color adjustment of picture White paper G: Green A: Amber M: Magenta B: Blue • • • • MENU 1 WB Adjust Back Reset70 Adjusting the color temperature You can change the white balance by adjusting the color temperature. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1/ 1) → White Balance. 3 Select the Color Temp. option, and then press [Fn]. 4 Set the color temperature by rotating the dial or pressing [W/X]. 5 Press [ ] to save. What is color temperature? Color temperature refers to the temperature that has expressed the color change of light in the absolute temperature (K). This can express cold sense with the rising color temperature and warm sense with the falling color temperature. Clear sky Fluorescent_H Cloudy Daylight Fluorescent_L Halogen lamp Incandescent bulb Candle light Brightness and color adjustment of picture MENU 1 K Adjust Back Reset 5500 K71 Color space You can set the color space the camera uses. 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting mode. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Color Space → an option. RGB sRGB Set the color space to sRGB. RGB Adobe RGB Set the color space to Adobe RGB. What is color space? The image In/Output devices such as digital camera, monitor and printer hold different ranges of reproducing each color. The possible range of color reproduction is referred to as color space. Several standards of color space are fixed for each device. This camera support sRGB and Adobe RGB. sRGB is diversely used in the devices like computer. It is recommended to use sRGB for regular images. sRGB standards for International standard of color space established by the IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission). This is defined from color space for PC monitors and is also used as the standard color space for Exif. Adobe RGB is the color space recommended by Adobe Systems, Inc. for commercial printing and has wider range of color reproduction than sRGB. Adobe RGB covers most of the color range so colors only available when printed are not lost when editing images from a computer. When image is opened by non-compatible software, the colors look lighter. Brightness and color adjustment of picture • When you set the color space to Adobe RGB, the camera saves picture files in the "_SAMXXXX.JPG" format. • You can set the Color Space function directly by pressing [Fn] in the Shooting mode.72 Smart range Smart Range automatically corrects for the loss of bright detail that can occur due to shading differences in the picture. ▲ Canceling smart range ▲ Use of smart range 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 3 ( 3) → Smart Range → an option. • When you turn on Smart Range, you cannot select the ISO 100 option. • The Smart range function is not available in some shooting modes, and it may automatically operate while you use the and shooting options. • You can set the Smart Range function directly by pressing [Fn] in the Shooting mode. Brightness and color adjustment of picture73 Changing the shooting method It can be difficult to take a picture of a fast moving object, a quick facial expression, or the rapid motion of a person. In this case, please select the successive shooting option appropriate for the situation. Successive shooting method and timer setup You can select the successive shooting option appropriate for the situation. 1 In Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 2 ( 2) → Drive → an option. Drive mode button You can can set this option directly by pressing the [ ] in the Shooting mode. Single Take one photo shot whenever you press the shutter. Continuous Take shots successively while pressing and holding down the shutter, possible to take 3 shots per second Burst Press the shutter button and the camera takes up to 30 shots in a row. Timer Press the shutter button and the camera takes a picture within 2 to 30 seconds. AE BKT When you press the shutter, the camera takes 3 consecutive shots: the original, one a step darker, and one a step lighter. WB BKT When the shutter is pressed the camera will take 3 consecutive shots, the original and 2 more with different white balance settings. P Wiz BKT When the shutter is pressed, the camera will take 3 consecutive shots; all three will have different picture wizard settings. • The options may differ depending on the Shooting mode. • The WB BKT and P Wiz BKT functions correct the image after you take the shot. • If you set the photo quality to the RAW format, you can not use the bracketing options (WB BKT, P Wiz BKT). • When you select the Burst shooting option, you can not select the image size, and the image quality is fixed at 1472x976. Also, when you are shooting using the Burst option, the camera can take longer to save the images. • With the Burst shooting option, the camera can not save images in the RAW file format. Also, you can not set the ISO to 100. • Both the built-in and external flash do not fire when you use the Burst shooting option. • The shutter speed can be set to 1/30 Sec or faster when the Burst shooting option is in use. • This product supports Burst Shooting mode which takes up to 30 shots per second. The images taken in Burst Shooting can be saved with a little bit enlarged size.74 Detailed bracket setup The details for the exposure, white balance and picture wizard of bracket shot can be set. 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting mode. 2 Select Shooting 3 ( 3) → BKT Set → an option. 3 Select the detailed options. AE BKT Set When using the exposure BKT function, this allows setting the image shot sequence and exposure interval. BKT Order: Set the shooting orders BKT Area: Set the exposure steps WB BKT Set When using the WB BKT function, this allows setting the adjusted interval of white balance value. Example) MG-/+3 adjusts the Magenta value of 3 steps minus or plus. P Wiz BKT Set When using the picture wizard BKT function, this allows setting the shot order. MENU OK 3 BKT Set AE BKT Set WB BKT Set P Wiz BKT Set AB -/+3 Changing the shooting method Exit Change OK 3 P Wiz BKT Set Standard Vivid Portrait Landscape Forest Retro Select Set75 Special effect/photo retouching Picture wizard The Picture Wizard function lets you select various looks and emotional moods for your pictures. T Example Standard Vivid Portrait Landscape Forest Retro Cool Calm Classic 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Picture Wizard → an option. 3 Adjust the detailed items of picture wizard that were selected by using [S/T/W/X]. • You can control the color, saturation, sharpness and contrast. 4 Set to a desired value. • The option can be set directly by pressing the [ ] button of camera in the shooting mode. MENU Vivid P L F R Cool CA Color ■ 0 0 0 V Saturation Sharpness Contrast Exit Move76 Special effect/photo retouching Custom picture wizard setup You can choose the customize options and then save images in 3 different ways. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Shooting 1 ( 1) → Picture Wizard → Custom → an option. 3 Adjust the Picture Wizard value by using [S/T/W/X] • You can control the color, saturation, sharpness, and contrast. 4 Set to a desired value. MENU Custom1 P L F R Cool CA C1 Color ■ 0 0 0 Saturation Sharpness Contrast Exit Move Classic77 Key Mapping Setting Key Mapping The function of camera button can be changed. 1 In the Shooting mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select User setup ( 1) → Key Mapping → an option. AEL You can choose among three settings for the [AEL] button: - AEL, which executes the auto exposure lock function. - AFL, which executes the auto focus lock function. - AEL + AFL, which executes the auto exposure and focus lock functions together. Preview You can chose between two settings for the Depth Preview button: - One-Touch WB which executes the Custom White Balance function. - Optical Preview which executes the Depth of Field Preview function for the current aperture value. What is AEL function? The auto exposure lock (AEL) and auto focus lock (AFL) functions of the camera are the functions that maintain the settings until the shooting is completed by remembering the exposure value and focus when pushing the [AEL] button of camera. Reaction of the half-shutter release when the AEL button is set to the following status. Status of AEL setting Reaction of the half-shutter release AEL Auto focus AFL Exposure lock AEL+AFL None • While shooting a movie, push the [Depth Preview] button once to activate the AF function and once again to cancel the function. • Refer to the “Depth Preview” function. (p. 37) • The function of AEL button cannot be changed in the M(manual) mode.Playback/Editing Learn how to play back and edit photos/videos. Also, learn how to connect your camera to your computer, photo printer, TV, or HDTV. Play (picture/movie) …………………………………… 79 Picture editing ………………………………………… 87 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV ………………………… 91 Transferring files to your computer ………………… 93 Using the Samsung RAW Converter ………………… 99 Printing photos with a photo printer (PictBridge) ……… 10279 Viewing pictures in the play mode You can view saved pictures and movies. 1 Press [ ] • Shows most recently saved file. 2 View the pictures sequentially using [W/X]. • When the playback screen is selected more than once, the last shown picture or movie is selected to be shown during playback. Photo playback information screens The display information appears by pressing [DISP] in the play mode. 1 RAW file indicator 2 File that includes development info 3 Protected file indicator 4 File no. 5 Meta value of picture 6 Shutter speed info 7 Aperture value 8 ISO setup value info 9 File playing/total no. of files stored/battery information Play (picture/movie) 1/250 F5.1 ISO 100 00004/00009 100-0001 Mode Flash Focal Length White balance EVC Picture size Date 8 9 4 5 6 7 3 2 18mm 0.0 4592 X 3056 2010.01.01 RAW 180 1 Shot image 2 RGB histogram 3 Shooting mode, metering, flash, white balance, picture wizard, focal length 4 Shutter speed, aperture value, ISO, selected file/total number of files/ battery information Movie playback information screen 1 Volume control display 2 Protected file 3 File no. 4 Meta value of movie 5 Fast forward 6 Total play time of selected file 7 Current play time 8 Rewind Play (picture/movie) OK WWaWW WXaWW 100-0001 1280 X 720 2010.01.01 Video size Date 3 4 1 7 6 8 5 2 1/40 F3.5 ISO 100 00004/00009 0.0 4592 X 3056 2010.01.01 R G B 1 2 3 4 Y RAW 18mm Play Capture81 View files in the smart album by category The files can be classified and shown by the file, date (day), date (week), and type. 1 In Playback mode, press [ ]. 2 Press [MENU]. 3 Select a desired playback method. Type Classify by the saved file form Date Classify by date recorded. Week Classify by week recorded. 4 You can view items by turning the dial or pressing [W/X]. 5 Press [ ] to return to the previous function. Converting to the thumbnail view Since several files can be shown on one display, files can be searched quickly. To have a thumbnail view of 9 images, press [ ] two times, or press [ ] three times to have a thumbnail view of 20 images. (Press [ ] to cancel) Play (picture/movie) When you start Smart Album or change the filter method, the time it takes for the camera to classify and display files depends on the number of files saved. Please wait a until Smart Album appears. MENU 2010. 1. 1 19 25 19 53 22 Filter MENU 2010. 1. 1 19 25 19 53 22 Type Date Week Filter 82 File protection You can protect files from accidental deletion. 1 Press [AEL] in the play mode. 2 appears on the display. 3 Press [AEL] to cancel. Deleting a file Files can be selected and deleted in the play mode. The function can be set by pressing [MENU] in the playback mode. Deleting one picture You can delete only one picture by selecting a desired file. 1 After selecting the file to be deleted in the play mode, press [ ]. 2 From the popup window, select Yes. Deleting selected file 1 After selecting the file to be deleted in the play mode, press [ ]. 2 From the popup window, select Multiple Delete. 3 After selecting a file to be deleted, press [ ]. • To cancel your selection, press [ ] again. 4 Press [ ] 5 From the popup window, select Yes. Play (picture/movie)83 Deleting all files All the files saved in the memory card can be deleted at once. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Delete → All. 3 From the popup window, select Yes. Auto rotate Show the pictures taken in the vertical frame by rotating them automatically while in playing. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Auto Rotate → On. High Light This informs the excessively bright part from the image taken. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → High Light → On. Play (picture/movie) If the photo shot is taken when the direction of the camera was aimed at the bottom, the direction of the image can be different in the playback mode.84 Enlargement/reduction A picture can be enlarged when searching in play mode. Enlargement Press [ ] to enlarge. (Press [ ] to reduce) Move enlargement on screen Press [S/T/W/X]. Trim the enlarged image Press the [Fn] button to select a portion of the image to be cut. See the slide show Pictures can be shown in a slide show by applying various effects and music. 1 In Playback mode, press [MENU] → [ ]. 2 Select a desired option • To play without selecting an option, go to step 4. Images Select the pictures you want in the slide show. • All : Include all the saved pictures in the slide show. • Date : Include pictures taken on a specific date in the slide show. • Select : Select pictures and see them in the slide show Effect • Select the transition effects between pictures. • In order not to use the changing effect, select the off option. Interval • Select the scene changing time Music Execute the background music Play (picture/movie) OK Fn x1.7 Magnified part Magnification (The maximum magnification may differ by resolution) Full Image Trim85 3 Set to a desired option. 4 Select Slide Show → Play. • To play the slide show repeatedly, please select the repeat option. 5 Watch the slide show • To stop slide show, press [ ] and then press [W/X]. Pause/Play Press the [ ] button. View a movie While a movie is being played back, you are able to select and cut a desired part of the scene. 1 After selecting a desired movie in the play mode, press [ ]. 2 Enjoy movie. Rewind Press [W] Pause/Play Press [ ]. Fast rewind Press [X] Volume control Turn the dial to the left/right Stop Press [S] Play (picture/movie) OK WWaW[ PLAY WXaWW 100-0001 Pause Stop86 Capturing a picture You can capture a frame of the movie as a picture while playing back the movie. 1 Press [ ] in the play mode. 2 Press [ ] while playing a movie. 3 Press [T] in the pause state. Cutting part of a movie 1 Press [ ] in the play mode. 2 Select the start point to cut by pressing [ ] → [ ] while playing a movie. 3 Select the end point of cutting by pressing [ ] → [ ]. 4 From the popup window, press Yes. Play (picture/movie) • The resolution of the captured image is the same as the movie resolution. • The captured file is saved as a separate file under a new file name. • The cut file is saved by using a different file name.87 Picture editing Pictures can be edited in various ways by using the edit menu. The function can be set directly by pressing [Fn] in the shooting mode. Changing the resolution 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Image Edit → Resize. 3 Select desired image resolution. • The edited file is saved by using the different file name. Rotating 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Image Edit → Rotate. 3 Select a desired rotation state • The resolution to be changed will be limited according to the resolution of original picture. Depending on the size of the picture, when you rotate the original, the new file may be smaller compared to the original. Resize Rotate88 Red-eye fix 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Red-eye Fix. Adjusting the backlight 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Backlight. Picture style Selecting picture style allows you to express various moods of emotion in your picture. 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Photo Style Selector. 3 Set to a desired option. Face retouching 1 After selecting a desired picture in the play mode, press [MENU]. 2 Select Playback [ ] → Image Edit → Face Retouch. 3 Set to a desired option. • The level of face retouch gets better as the value becomes larger. Picture editing89 Setting the print info (DPOF) The size and number of copies to be printed can be designated for the picture. Since the designated information is saved in the MISC folder of memory card, it is convenient to print the designated size and number of copies while using the pictures of designated info simply by taking the memory card to a digital printing shop. 1 Press [MENU] → Playback [ ] → DPOF → Standard in the playback mode. 2 Select a desired option Select Printing selected pictures All Printing all Reset Initializing the standard print option 3 When having made the selections, press [Fn] after selecting the picture and number of copies to be printed by using the dial. • When having selected all, press [S/T] to select the number of copies to be printed and then, press [ ]. • The print info you enter can only be used for the digital printer or digital picture printing shop that supports the digital print order format (DPOF). • For pictures with a wide resolution, the left and right portion of the image may not be printed. When placing a print order, identify the wide resolution pictures. • The DPOF option is not available for RAW formatted images and the movie files. Picture editing90 4 Select [MENU] → DPOF → SIZE in the playback mode. 5 Select an option Select Select desired print size according to the picture. All Select the print size of all the pictures saved in the memory card. Reset Initializing the print size option 6 When having selected the select option, select the picture to be printed and press [Fn] after selecting the print size by using the dial. • When having selected all, press [S/T] and select the print size. Then, select the print size and press [ ]. Index printing 1 Press [MENU] → Playback [ ] → DPOF → Index in the playback mode. 2 From the popup window, press Yes. Picture editing The designated print size can only be applied onto the DPOF1.1 compatible printer. 91 Viewing files on a TV or HDTV Play back photos or videos by connecting your camera to a TV using the provided A/V cable. Viewing files on a regular TV 1 Select a video signal output according to your country or region. (p. 108) 2 Connect the TV and the camera using the A/V cable. 3 Make sure the TV and camera are turned on and select the video output mode of TV. 4 View the videos and pictures using the buttons of camera body. On some TVs, digital noise may occur or part of an image may not appear. Images may not appear centered on the TV screen depending on your TV settings. You cannot capture photos or videos while the camera is connected to a TV. • • • Video Audio92 Viewing files on an HDTV 1 Select a video signal output according to your country or region. (p. 108) 2 In Shooting or Playback mode, select [MENU] → Setting 3 ( 3 ) → HDMI Size → an option. 3 Connect the HDTV and the camera using the HDMI cable. 4 Make sure the HDTV and camera are turned on and select the HDMI mode of TV. • The HDTV screen shows the same display of the camera. 5 View the videos and pictures using the buttons of camera body. When using the HDMi cable, the user can connect the camera to an HDTV using the Anynet+(CEC) method. The Anynet+(CEC) functions allows you to control connected devices using the TV remote control. In the case that the HDTV supports Anynet+(CEC), the power of the TV is automatically turned on when used in conjunction with the caemra. When connected to an HDTV by an HDMI cable, the camera can not take a pictures or movies. When connected to an HDTV, some playback functions may not be available. • • • • Viewing files on a TV or HDTV HDMI cable If both A/V and HDMI cables are connected at the same time, the HDMI cable has the highest priority. We recommend you disconnect the A/V cable for better playback.93 Transferring files to your computer For Windows users Transfer files by connecting your camera to your PC. Installing programs Hardware and software requirements Item Requirements CPU Intel Pentium 4 3.2GHz or higher RAM 1GB or more (2 GB or more recommended) OS Windows XP SP2/Vista/7 Hard disk capacity 250 MB or more (1 GB or more recommended) Others USB port CD-ROM drive 1024 x 768 pixels, 16-bit color display compatible monitor (32-bit color display recommended) Microsoft Direct X 9.0c or later • • • • Programs contained on the CD Program Purpose Intelli-studio Edit photos and videos. Samsung RAW Converter Convert RAW files into the desired file format. Using a self-assembled PC or a PC and OS that are not supported may void your warranty. The programs may not work properly on 64-bit Edition of Windows XP, Vista and 7. • • Intelli-studio may not perform correctly on some computers, even when the computer meets the requirements. If your computer does not meet the requirements, videos may not play correctly or it may take longer to edit videos. Install DirectX 9.0c or above before you use the program. You must use Windows XP/Vista/7 or Mac OS 10.4 or later to connect the camera as a removable disk. • • • •94 Transferring files to your computer 1 Insert the installation CD in a compatible CDROM drive. 2 When the setup screen is displayed, click Samsung Digital Camera Installer to start installation. 3 Select programs to install, and follow the onscreen instructions. 4 Click Exit to complete the installation, and then restart your computer. Transferring files to your PC When you connect the camera to your PC, the PC recognizes the camera as a removable drive. 1 Connect your camera to your PC with the USB cable. You must plug the end of the cable with the correct connection plug into your camera. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data.95 2 Turn on the camera. • In the popup window, select Computer. 3 On your PC, select My Computer→ Removable Disk→DCIM→ "XXXPHOTO," or select "XXX_MMDD" folder. 4 Select the files you want, and then drag or save them to your PC. Disconnecting the camera (for Windows XP) The way to disconnect the USB cable for Windows 2000 and Vista is similar. 1 It the status lamp on your camera is blinking, it means the data transfer is in progress. Please wait until the status lamp stops blinking. 2 Click on the tool bar at the bottom right of your PC screen. 3 Click the pop-up message. 4 Remove the USB cable. Transferring files to your computer If the Folder Type is set to Date, the folder name appears as "XXX_MMDD." For example, if shot at January 1st, the folder name appears as "101_0101." • •96 For Mac users When you connect the camera to a Macintosh computer, the computer recognizes the camera automatically. You can transfer files directly from the camera to the computer without installing any programs. 1 Connect your camera to a Macintosh computer with the USB cable. 2 Turn on the camera. In the popup window, select Computer. 3 Double-click the removable disk icon. 4 Transfer photos or videos to the computer. • When using the USB cable, make sure to match the plugs on the cable to the USB jacks on the camera and computer. If the cable is reversed, it may damage your files. The manufacturer is not responsible for any loss of data. Please use only the accessories that SAMSUNG provides. The manufacturer takes no responsibility for any loss of files or damage that may result from the use of other manufacturer’s product. • • Mac OS 10.4 or later is supported. Transferring files to your computer97 Using Intelli-studio Once you have installed the Intelli-studio on your PC, the Intelli-studio starts automatically when a camera is connected with your PC. If the Intelli-studio does not start after you have connected the camera to your PC, double-click the Intelli-studio icon on your Windows desktop. The Intelli-studio allows you to play back and edit files. You can also upload files to websites, such as Flickr or YouTube. For details, select [Menu → Help] in the program. Transferring files to your computer You cannot edit files directly on the camera. Transfer files to a folder on your computer before editing. You cannot copy files in your computer to the camera. Intelli-studio supports the following formats: - Videos: AVI(MJPEG), MP4 (Video: H.264, Audio: AAC), WMV (WMV 7/8/9) - Photos: JPG, GIF, BMP, PNG, TIFF • • •98 Icon Description 1 Open menus 2 Display files in the selected folder 3 Change to the Photo edit mode 4 Change to the Video edit mode 5 Change to the Sharing mode (You can send files by email or upload files to websites, such as Flickr or YouTube.) 6 Enlarge or reduce the thumbnails in the list 7 Select a file type 8 View files of the selected folder on your computer 9 Show or hide files of the connected camera 10 View files of the selected folder on the camera 11 View files as thumbnails, in Smart Album, or on a map 12 Browse folders in the connected device 13 Browse folders in your computer 14 Move to the previous or next folder 15 Print files, view files on a map, store files in My Folder, or register faces Transferring files using Intelli-studio Intelli-studio will start automatically when you connect the camera to your computer with the USB cable. 1 Connect the camera to your computer with the USB cable. 2 Turn on the camera. The computer recognizes the camera automatically. 3 Select a folder on your computer to save new files. If your camera has no new files, the pop-up window for saving new files will not appear. 4 Select Yes. New files will be transferred to the computer. • • • Transferring files to your computer If the camera fails to connect, a pop-up window will appear. Select Computer. For Windows Vista, select Run Installer.exe from the AutoPlay window.99 Using the Samsung RAW Converter Using the Samsung RAW Converter, you can develop RAW files after editing them as you like. You can also edit JPEG or TIFF files in the same way you edit the RAW files. This software is only compatible with Windows XP, Vista and 7. To start the program, click [Start → All Programs → Samsung RAW Converter → Samsung RAW Converter] Editing the RAW files Image edit functions are listed below. Ì Menu bar Í Image editing tools [Exposure bias]: Compensates the exposure value. [White balance]: Adjusts the white balance value. [Color]: Adjusts the color of the image. [Tone]: Changes the color tone. [Sharpness/ Noise reduction]: Adjusts the sharpness. [Development]: Previewing is available for the final output. Highlight controller Adjusts the saturation and highlights of the selected image. Histogram Displays the color layers of the selected image. Preview window Displays the selected image. • Refer to the [Help] menu in the Samsung RAW Converter for further information. You can download the Samsung RAW Converter program for Macintosh from the Samsung website. • • ② ① ⑤ ③ ④100 Using the Samsung RAW Converter Correcting the exposure The main feature of the Samsung RAW Converter is that you can keep the best quality of the images as you make changes to the RAW files while editing. After making changes to the brightness or contrast, you can still obtain the same result no matter which you change first. The following images show how you can change the exposure on an image using the Samsung RAW Converter. You can adjust the exposure by using the menu option as shown in the picture below. You can see the results of the exposure adjustment in the histograms below: ▲ Original image P Mode, Aperture: f = 8, Shutter Speed: 1/15sec, ISO = 100 ▲ Changed image after correcting the exposure. ▲ Original image ▲ Changed image after correcting the exposure. Menu option for adjusting the exposure.101 Using the Samsung RAW Converter Handling the JPEG/TIFF files as you edit RAW files Using the Samsung RAW Converter, you can edit JPEG/TIFF files in the same way you edit RAW files. You can adjust the white balance, sharpness, and reducing the noise is also available. The following images show how to change the contrast on a TIFF image using the Samsung RAW Converter. You can adjust the contrast by using the menu option as shown in the picture. Saving the RAW files in JPEG or TIFF format You can save the RAW files in JPEG or TIFF format using the Samsung RAW Converter. 1. Choose the image you want to edit, and then select [File(F)] → [Development...]. 2. Select the type of file as JPEG or TIFF and then click [Save(S)]. - The selected file is saved as JPEG or TIFF format. ▲ Original image P Mode, Aperture: f = 8, Shutter Speed: 1/15sec, ISO = 100 ▲ Changed image after correcting the contrast. Menu option for adjusting the contrast102 Printing photos with a photo printer (PictBridge) Print photos with a PictBridge-compatible printer by connecting your camera directly to the printer. 1 With the printer on, connect your camera to the printer with a USB cable. 2 Turn on your camera. Select Printer in the popup window. 3 Press [W/X] to select a photo. Press [MENU] to set printing options. 4 Press [ ] to print. • • Configuring print settings Print MENU Exit 1 2 Images Size Layout Type Quality Date One Photo Auto Auto Auto Auto Auto Images Select whether to print the current photo or all photos. Size Specify the size of the print. Layout Create thumbnail prints. Type Select the type of paper. Quality Set the printing quality. Date Set to print the date. File Name Set to print the name of the file. Reset Reset the print options. If your printer has the mass storage feature, you must first set the USB mode to Printer in the settings menu. • Some options are not supported by some printers.Camera settings menu You can set the camera use environment using the setup menu. Camera settings menu ……………………………… 104104 1 Press [MENU] in the shooting or play mode. 2 Select a desired setup menu 3 Select a desired item 4 Press [MENU] to return to the previous mode. Camera settings menu You can set the camera use environment using the setup menu. MENU OK 1 2 1 1 2 3 Quickview Display Adjust Display Save Power Save Date&Time Sound 1sec 3min 1min 3 Setup menu items MENU OK 2 Sound System Volume AF Sound Button Sound Medium On On Exit Change Exit Change105 Sound System Volume You can set the camera use environment using the setup menu. (Off, Low, Medium*, High) AF Sound Sets the sound the camera makes in AF mode on or off. (Off, On*) Button Sound Sets the sound the camera makes when you press buttons on or off. (Off, On*) Display Language Select the language the camera shows on the display. Display Adjust Adjust the display brightness, auto brightness setting, or display color. Display Brightness: You can adjust the display brightness using the [S/T] to one of five brightness levels. Auto Brightness: Adjust the brightness of screen. Display Color: Depending on whether the user uses the screen or the viewfinder, the display color can be adjusted by using the [S/T/W/X]. Display Save Sets the display off time. (Off, 0.5min*, 1min, 3min, 5min, 10min) Quickview This allows setting the quick view (view immediately upon a shot) time. (Off, 1sec*, 3sec, 5sec, Hold) Camera settings menu * Default value * Default value106 Normal setup 1( 1 ) Format This formats the memory card (deleting all the files including protected files). (Yes, No*) Error can occur if using a card formatted by another brand of camera, memory card reader or computer. Please use the card after formatting it from the camera. Reset This resets the setup menu and shooting options. (The date, time, language, and video output value are kept.) (Yes, No*) File Name This sets the method of designating filename. Standard* : SAM_XXXX.JPG(sRGB)/_SAMXXXX.JPG(Adobe RGB) Date : MMDDXXXX.JPG(sRGB)/_MDDXXXX.JPG(Adobe RGB, Jan. ~ Sep.)/ _ADDXXXX.JPG(Adobe RGB, indicating A for Oct, B for Nov, C for Dec) For example, the image taken by setting Jan 01 sRGB is saved in "0101xxxx.jpg". File Number This sets the method of designating file number. (Series*, Reset) • The folder name that has taken pictures for the first time becomes 100PHOTO and the filename will be SAM_0001 (when the color space is sRGB). • The filename number is increased by 1 in the range of SAM_0001~ SAM_9999. • File name numbers are increased by 1 from SAM_0001 to SAM_9999. • Folder numbers are increased by 1 from 100PHOTO to 999PHOTO. • The maximum number of files that can be saved in one folder is 9999. • File names are assigned according to DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) specifications. • If you change a file name (for example, on a computer), the camera will not be able to play the file. Folder Type This sets the type of folder. Standard* : XXXPHOTO Date : XXX_MMDD * Default value Camera settings menu107 Power Save This sets the power turned off automatically if not being used for a while. (0.5 min, 1min*, 3min, 5min, 10min, 30min) • The camera retains the power-off time setting even if you replace the battery. • Power Save may not work if the camera is connected to a computer, TV, or printer, playing a slide show or movie. Date & Time This sets the date and time. (Type, Date, Time Zone, Time, Imprint) • Only the date is shown on the lower right side of the picture in play. • When printing a picture, the date may not be printed appropriately from certain manufacturer or printer model. Camera settings menu * Default value Normal setup 2( 2 ) 108 Display Select Auto Select* : Convert between Main Display and EVF by eye sensor Main Display : The screen will be shown only through Main Display EVF : The screen will be shown only through EVF Video Out Select the video output signal appropriate for your country when connecting the camera to an external video device such as a monitor or TV. NTSC* : US, Canada, Japan, Korea, Taiwan, Mexico, etc. PAL (supporting only the BDGHI method) : Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Holland, Finland, Germany, England, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, Norway, etc. Anynet+ (HDMICEC) When you connect the camera to an HDTV that supports Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC), you can control the play function of the camera with the TV remote controller (p. 91). On* : You can control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. Off : You can NOT control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. HDMI Size The resolution on an HDTV can be changed when using an HDMI cable. (In case of NTSC method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 480p) (In case of PAL method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 576p) If the connected HDTV does not support the selected resolution, you select, the camera sets the resolution one level lower. Firmware Update Displays the firmware version of the camera body and lens, and upgrades the firmware. Body Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the camera body. Lens Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the lens. • You can upgrade the firmware by downloading it from www.samsung.com. • You can not run a firmware upgrade without a fully charged the battery. Recharge the battery fully before running a firmware upgrade or attach the adaptor to provide power (optional). • After upgrading the firmware, the user customized options are reset to the default value. (The date, time, language, and video output values are kept.) Camera settings menu * Default value Normal setup 3( 3 ) Display Select Auto Select* : Convert between Main Display and EVF by eye sensor Main Display : The screen will be shown only through Main Display EVF : The screen will be shown only through EVF Video Out Select the video output signal appropriate for your country when connecting the camera to an external video device such as a monitor or TV. NTSC* : US, Canada, Japan, Korea, Taiwan, Mexico, etc. PAL (supporting only the BDGHI method) : Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Holland, Finland, Germany, England, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, Norway, etc. Anynet+ (HDMICEC) When you connect the camera to an HDTV that supports Anynet+ (HDMI-CEC), you can control the play function of the camera with the TV remote controller (p. 91). On* : You can control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. Off : You can NOT control the play function of camera with the TV remote controller. HDMI Size The resolution on an HDTV can be changed when using an HDMI cable. (In case of NTSC method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 480p) (In case of PAL method : Auto*, 1080i, 720p, 576p) If the connected HDTV does not support the selected resolution, you select, the camera sets the resolution one level lower. Firmware Update Displays the firmware version of the camera body and lens, and upgrades the firmware. Body Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the camera body. Lens Firmware: Upgrades the firmware of the lens. • You can download firmware upgrades from www.samsungimaging.co.kr or www.samsung.com. • You can not run a firmware upgrade without a fully charged the battery. Recharge the battery fully before running a firmware upgrade or attach the adaptor to provide power (optional). • After upgrading the firmware, the user customized options are reset to the default value. (The date, time, language, and video output values are kept.)Appendixes Refer to error messages, specifications, and maintenance tips. Error messages ……………………………………… 110 Camera maintenance ………………………………… 111 Before contacting a service center …………………… 115 Camera specifications ………………………………… 118 Lens specifications …………………………………… 122 Accessories (optional items) ………………………… 123 Index …………………………………………………… 125110 Error message Suggested remedies Card Error Turn off your camera, and then turn it on again. Remove your memory card, and then insert it again. Format your memory card. (p. 106) • • • Card Locked Unlock the memory card. DCF Full Error File names do not match the DCF standard. Transfer the files on the memory card to your computer and format the card. (p. 106) File Error Delete the damaged file or contact a service center. Low Battery Insert a charged battery or recharge the battery. Memory Full Delete unnecessary files or insert a new memory card. No Image File Take photos or insert a memory card that has some photos. Check the lens. Check whether dust or foreign substances between Lens contacts and Lens mount index. Remove either dust or foreign substances if dirt or foreign substances are appeared. Please be care for avoid getting dirt foreign substances inside the camera. Error 00 Turn off the camera, remove the lens, and then mount the lens again. Error 01/02 Turn off the camera, remove the battery, and then insert it again. Error messages When the following error messages appear, try these remedies.111 Cleaning your camera Camera lens and display Use a blower brush to remove dust and wipe the lens gently with a soft cloth. If any dust remains, apply lens cleaning liquid to a piece of lens cleaning paper and wipe gently. About dust in the image sensor Depending on the different shooting conditions, dust may appear in the photo images because the image sensor can be exposed to the external environment. This is not a problem of the product, and the exposure to dust can occur in everyday use of camera. When using the dust blower, do not insert the blower through the lens mount, the camera may malfunction. In that case, please contact to the service center. Camera body Wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. Camera maintenance Never use benzene, thinners, or alcohol to clean the device. These solutions can damage the camera or cause it to malfunction. •112 About memory cards Memory cards you can use You can use SD (Secure Digital) and SDHC (Secure Digital High Capacity) memory cards. Terminal Label (front) Write-protect switch You can prevent files from being deleted by using the write-protect switch on the SD or SDHC card. Slide the switch down to lock or slide it up to unlock. Lock the card to prevent deletions. Unlock the card when shooting. Memory card capacity The memory capacity may vary depending on the scenes you shoot or the shooting conditions. These capacities are based on a 1GB SD card: Size Super Fine Fine Normal RAW RAW+SF RAW+F RAW+N Photos 14M (3:2) 142 278 408 35 28 31 32 10M (3:2) 197 382 724 - 32 34 36 6M (3:2) 322 615 1128 - 36 38 39 2M (3:2) 738 1334 2238 - 41 42 43 12M (16:9) 168 328 630 - 30 33 35 8M (16:9) 234 454 860 - 34 36 37 5M (16:9) 381 727 1334 - 38 39 40 2M (16:9) 872 1573 2638 - 42 43 43 Burst 1201 2092 3320 - - - - Size HQ Normal *Movies (30fps) 1280 (16:9) Approx. 15mins Approx. 22mins 640 (4:3) Approx. 44mins Approx. 66mins 320 (4:3) Approx. 145mins Approx. 210mins * The time available for recording may differ if you use the zoom. Several movies were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. Camera maintenance113 About the battery Use only Samsung-approved batteries. Battery specifications Mode BP1310 Type Lithium-ion battery Cell capacity 1300 mAh Voltage 7.4 V Charging time (When fully discharged) Approx. 150 min Battery life Shooting mode Number of photos Photos Approx. 200 min/Approx. 400 photos Videos Approx. 130 min The figures above are measured by Samsung’s standards and may differ depending on actual usage. The shooting time may change depending on the shooting environment and shot intervals. Several videos were recorded in succession to determine the total recording time. • • • Camera maintenance114 Notes about charging the battery If the charging indicator light does not light, make sure that the battery is inserted correctly. If the indicator light blinks in red or does not illuminate, reconnect the adaptor cable, or remove the battery and insert it again. If you charge the battery when it is warm, the indicator light may turn orange. Charging will start when the battery cools down. When using the battery, please keep the following guidelines. Failure to follow these guidleline may cause excessive heat, fire, or explosion. If the battery is bulging or distorted, contact a Samsung service center. It may present a physical danger. It may present physical dangers. Use only the recommended battery charger. Do not place the product close to any high temperature source. Do not insert the product into a microwave. Do not place the product inside a car during the summer. Do not place the product in a hot, humid environment. Do not place the camera on a carpet, comforter, or electronic mattress for a long time. Do not leave the product turned on where there is little or no air circulation. Do not let accessories like necklaces, coins, keys, watches, etc., come in contact with the battery chamber. • • • - - - - - - - - - - - Use Advanced Lithium Batteries with a guarantee from the manufacturing company Do not disassemble the battery or perforate the battery with a pin. Do not subject the battery or camera to high pressure. Do not drop or strike the camera or battery, or subject either to rough handling or sudden shocks. Do not expose the battery or camera to temperatures over 60ºC (140ºF) degree. Do not expose the product to water or humidity. Battery shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as sunshine, fire or the like. Guidelines of disposal Follow the disposal instructions and properly dispose of the used battery. Do not dispose of the battery by throwing it in a fire. Disposal instructions may differ depending on your country or specifi c region. Follow the disposal instructions of your country, state, etc. Guideline of recharging the battery. Do not recharge the battery using a method that differs from the method detailed in this users manual. Failure to follow these instruction may cause a fire or explosion. - - - - - - - - - - - - Camera maintenance115 Before contacting a service center If you are having trouble with your camera, try these troubleshooting procedures before contacting a service center. If you have attempted the troubleshooting solution and are still having problems with your device, contact your local dealer or authorized Samsung service center. Situation Suggested remedies Cannot turn on the camera Make sure that the battery is inserted. Make sure that the battery is inserted correctly. Charge the battery. • • • The power turns off suddenly Charge the battery. Your camera may be in Power save mode. (p. 107) The power automatically turns off to preven the camera from malfunctoning in the case that the unit overheats. • • • The camera is losing battery power quickly The battery may lose power more quickly in low temperatures (below 0° C). Keep the battery warm by putting it into your pocket. Using the flash or recording videos depletes the battery quickly. Recharge if needed. The ability of a Lithium battery to hold a charge dimishes over time. If your battery looses its charge rapidly on a regular basis, purchase a new battery. • • • Cannot take photos There is no space on the memory card. Delete unnecessary files or insert a new card. Format the memory card. (p. 106) The memory card is defective. Get a new memory card. The memory card is locked. Unlock the card. (p. 112) Make sure that the camera is switched on. Charge the battery. Make sure that the batte ry is inserted correctly. When you use the AF Priority function, you cannot take a picture without adjusting the focus on the subject correctly. Disable the AF Priority function, or set the focus accurately. • • • • • • • • The camera freezes Remove the battery, and then insert it again. The flash does not work The flash option may be set to Off. (p. 55) You cannot use the flash in the mode, or some modes. • • The flash fires unexpectedly The flash may fire due to static electricity. This is not a malfunction of the camera.116 Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies The date and time are incorrect Set the date and time in the Setting2 ( 2 ) menu. The display or buttons do not work Remove the battery, and then insert it again. The memory card has an error The memory card has not been reset. Format the card. (p. 106) Cannot play back files If you change the name of a file, your camera may not be able to play the file (the name of the file should meet the DCF standard). If you encounter this situation, play back files on your computer. The photo is blurry If the subject is out of focus, the photo may be blurry. Make a change to the shooting condition. If the camera is shaken while shooting, the photo may be blurry. Use a tripod to avoid camera shake. Make sure that the lens is clean. If not, clean the lens. (p. 111) • • • The colors in the photo do not match the actual scene An incorrect white balance can create unrealistic color. Select the proper white balance option to suit the light source. (p. 68) The photo is too bright Your photo is overexposed. Adjust the exposure value. (p. 66) Adjust the aperture value or the shutter speed. (p. 41) Turn off the flash. (p. 55) Adjust the ISO speed. (p. 59) • • • • The photo is too dark Your photo is underexposed. Adjust the exposure value. Adjust the aperture value or the shutter speed. Turn on the flash. Adjust the ISO speed. • • • • The photo is distorted The wide-angle lens may distort the image. This is a normal feature of the wide-angle lens.117 Before contacting a service center Situation Suggested remedies The TV does not display your photos Make sure that the camera is correctly connected to the TV with the A/V and HDMI cable. Make sure that your memory card contains photos. • • Your computer does not recognize your camera Make sure that the USB cable is connected correctly. Make sure that your camera is switched on. Make sure that you are using a supported operating system. • • • Your computer disconnects the camera while transferring files The fi le transmission may be interrupted by static electricity. Disconnect the USB cable, and then connect it again.118 Camera specifications Specification Image Sensor Type CMOS Sensor size 23.4×15.6mm Effective Pixel Approx. 14.6 Mega-pixels Total Pixel Approx. 15.1 Mega-pixels Color Filter RGB primary color filter Lens Mount Samsung NX Mount Usable Lens Samsung Lenses Image Stabilization Type Lens Shift (depends on Lens) Display Type LCD Size 3.0” Resolution QVGA (320x240). Approx. 230K dots Live view Field of view : Approx. 98% Viewfinder Type EVF Resolution QVGA Class (300X220). Approx. 201K dots equiv. Field of View Approx. 98% Magnification Approx. 0.83x (APS-C, 50mm, -1m-1) Eyepoint About 17 mm Diopter Adjustment Approx. -4.0 ~ +1.0m-1 Specification Focusing Type Contrast AF Focusing point Selection : 1point (Free selection) Multi : Normal 15points, Close Up 35points Face Detection : Max. 10faces Modes Single AF, Continuous AF, MF AF-assist lamp Yes (Green LED) Shutter Type Electronically controlled vertical-run focal plane shutter Speed Auto:1/4000sec. ~ 30sec. Manual:1/4000sec. ~ 30sec. (1/3EV or 1/2EV step) Bulb (Limit time : 8 min) Exposure Metering System TTL 247 (19x13) Block segment Metering : Multi, Centerweighted, Spot Metering range : EV0 ~ 18 (ISO100·30mm F2.0) Compensation ±3 EV (1/2EV, 1/3EV step) AE Lock AEL button ISO Equivalent Auto, 100, 200, 400, 800, 1600, 3200 (1EV step)119 Camera specifications Specification Drive Mode Modes Single, Continuous, Burst, Self-timer, Bracket (AE, WB, PW) Continuous JPEG : 3fps up to 10shots, Burst mode : 30fps, 30shots by 1 released RAW : 3fps up to 3shots Bracket Auto Exposure Bracket (±3EV), White Balance Bracket (±3step), Picture Wizard Bracket (Selectable 3modes) Self-timer 2-30sec. (1sec. step) Remote controller Wired : SR9NX01 (Optional) Specification Flash Type TTL Auto Pop-up flash Modes Smart Flash, Auto, Auto + Red-eye reduction, Fill-in, Fill-in + Red-eye reduction, 1 st Curtain, 2nd Curtain, OFF Guide Number 11 (at ISO 100) Angle of View Coverage 28mm wide-angle (Equivalent to 35mm) Sync. Speed Less than 1/180sec. Flash Compensation -2 - +2EV (0.5EV step) External Flash Samsung External Flash available (SEF42A, SEF20A) (optional) Synchro (Flash attachment) Hot Shoe White Balance Modes Auto, Daylight, Cloudy, Fluorescent (W, N, D), Tungsten, Flash, Custom, K(Manual) Micro adjustment Each 7steps in Amber / Blue / Green / Magenta axis Picture Wizard Modes Standard, Vivid, Portrait, Landscape, Forest, Retro, Cool, Calm, Classic, Custom (1-3) Parameter Contrast, Sharpness, Saturation, Color tone120 Camera specifications Specification Shooting Modes Smart Auto, Program, Shutter Priority AE, Aperture Priority AE, Manual, Night, Portrait, Landscape, Scene, Movie Scene Mode Beauty shot, Children, Close Up, Text, Sunset, Dawn, Backlight, Fireworks, Beach & Snow Image Size JPEG (3:2): 14M (4592x3056), 10M (3872x2592), 6M (3008x2000), 2M (1920x1280), 1.4M (1472x976): Burst mode only JPEG (16:9): 12M (4592x2584), 8M (3872x2176), 5M (3008x1688), 2M (1920x1080) RAW: 14M (4592x3056) Quality Super fine , Fine, Normal RAW Format SRW Color Space sRGB, Adobe RGB Specification Movie Format MP4 (H.264) Compression Movie : H.264 , Sound : AAC Movie Clip With Audio or without Audio (user selectable, recording time : 25 minutes) Image size 1280x720 , 640x480 , 320x240 Frame rate 30fps Sound Mono Sound Movie Editing Still Image Capture, Time Trimming Image Play Type Single image, Thumbnails (3/9/20 images), Slide show, Movie Highlight Warning Available Editing Red eye fix, Back light comp., Photo Style Selector, Resize, Rotate, Face Retouch Photo Style Selector Soft, Vivid, Forest, Autumn, Misty, Gloomy, Classic121 Camera specifications Specification Storage Media External memory card(optional): SD card (up to 4GB guaranteed), SDHC card (up to 8GB guaranteed) File Format RAW (SRW), JPEG (EXIF 2.21), DCF, DPOF 1.1, PictBridge 1.0 Capacity (1GB) 14M : RAW 35 14M : Super Fine 142, Fine 278, Normal 408 10M : Super Fine 197, Fine 382, Normal 724 6M : Super Fine 322, Fine 615, Normal 1128 2M : Super Fine 738, Fine 1334, Normal 2238 Burst (1.4M) : Super Fine 1201, Fine 2092, Normal 3320 12M(W) : Super Fine 168, Fine 328, Normal 630 8M(W) : Super Fine 234, Fine 454, Normal 860 5M(W) : Super Fine 381, Fine 727, Normal 1334 2M(W) : Super Fine 872, Fine 1573, Normal 2638 Movie : 1280x720 : High Quality 15min., Normal 22min. 640x480 : High Quality 44min., Normal 66min. 320x240 : High Quality 145min., Normal 210min. ※ These figures are measured under the Samsung standard Specification Direct Printing PictBridge Interface Digital Output Connector USB 2.0 (HI-SPEED) Video output NTSC, PAL (user selectable) HDMI 1.3 : (1080i, 720P, 576P / 480P) External Release Yes DC power input connector DC 9.0V, 1.5A (100 ~ 240V) Power Source Type Rechargeable battery : BP1310 (1300mAh) Charger: BC1310 AC Adaptor : AD9NX01 (Optional) * Included battery may vary depending on sales region Physical Specification Dimensions (WxHxD) 123×87×39.8mm (excluding the projecting parts of the camera) Weight 345g (without batteries and card) Operating Temperature 0 ~ 40 °C Operating Humidity 5 ~ 85% Software Application Intelli-studio, Samsung RAW Converter * Specifications are subject to change without prior notice * All trademarks are the property of their respective owners122 The lens provided may differ by the model. Lens specifications Lens Name SAMSUNG 30mm F2 SAMSUNG 18-55mm F3.5-5.6 OIS SAMSUNG 50-200mm F4-5.6 ED OIS Focal Length 30mm (equivalent to 46.2mm in 35mm format) 18 - 55mm (equivalent to 27.7-84.7mm in 35mm format) 50 - 200mm (equivalent to 77-308mm in 35mm format) Elements in Groups 5 elements in 5 groups (1 Aspherical lens included) 12 elements in 9 groups (1 Aspherical lens included) 17 elements in 13 groups (2 Extra-low Dispersion lens included) Angle of View 50.2° 75.9°- 28.7° 31.4°- 8.0° Aperture F2 (Min. F22), (Number of Blades : 7 , Circular Aperture Diaphragm) F3.5 - 5.6 (Min. F22), (Number of Blades : 7 , Circular Aperture Diaphragm) F4 - 5.6 (Min. F22), (Number of Blades : 7 , Circular Aperture Diaphragm) Mount Type Samsung NX Mount Samsung NX Mount Samsung NX Mount Optical Image Stabilizer No Yes Yes Minimum Focus Distance 0.25m ~ Ğ 0.28m ~ Ğ 0.98m ~ Ğ Maximum Magnification Approx. 0.16X Approx. 0.22X Approx. 0.2X Lens Hood Optional Included Included Filter Size 43mm 58mm 52mm Max. Diameter x Length 61.5 x 21.5mm 63 x 65.1mm 70 x 100.5mm Weight Approx. 85g (without hood) Approx. 198g (without hood) Approx. 417g (without hood) Operating Temperature 0 ~ 40°C 0 ~ 40°C 0 ~ 40°C Operating Humidity 5 ~ 85% 5 ~ 85% 5 ~ 85%123 Accessories (optional items) Lens Make better pictures with a 30mm, 18-55mm, or 50-200mm lens made exclusively for the Samsung NX-series camera. Memory card In this camera, the memory cards such as SD (Secure Digital) and SDHC (Secure Digital High Capacity) may be used. A/V cable The camera can be connected to an external device by using an A/V cable. Shutter release This product minimizes the possible shaking of camera when taking pictures by using a tripod or taking pictures at a low shutter speed. Adaptor The power needed in the camera can be supplied by connecting to a power socket using this adaptor.124 Accessories(optional items) Strap Straps can be purchased separately. Camera bag Camera bag can be purchased separately. Filter Optional filters can be purchased and attached to the lens. Flash Optional flash(SEF20A or SEF42A) can be purchased for your various shooting experience. HDMI Cable You can view high-quality and uncompressed photos or videos on an HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface) using the optional HDMI cable. Battery pack Battery pack can be purchased separately. The image of components or optional parts can differ from that of actual products. Please refer to the user's manual of the optional items.125 Index A Adjusting exposure 5 Automatic focus 34 Aperture priority mode 41 Aperture value 41 AF Priority 60 AF assist light 61 AE BKT 73 AEL function 77 AF Sound 105 Anynet+ 108 Appendixes 109 Accessories (optional items) 123 B Background 7 Bulb exposure 44 Bracket setup 74 Backlight adjustment 88 Button sound 105 Battery 18, 115 C Composition 7 Close-up 39 Continuous AF 60 Center-weighted metering 67 Color temperature 70 Color space 71 Changing the shooting method 73 Continuous shooting 73 Camera maintenance 111 Camera specifications 118 D Direction keys 5 Diopter adjustment dial 16 Display type 28 Depth of field 37 Depth Preview 37 Deleting a file 82 Display 105 Display Select 108 Date&Time 107 E Eye sensor 15 Eye-cup 16 EV button 43 External flash 58 Error message 110 F Fn 27 Flash popup button 55 Focusing methods 60 Face detection 64 File protection 82 Face retouching 88 Format 106 File name 106 File number 106 Folder type 106 Firmware update 108 H Half-shutter 32 HDTV 92 HDMI Size 108 I ISO sensitivity 59 Icons 25 Image stabilization 32 Index printing 90 Intelli-studio 97 J JPEG 101 K Key mapping 77 L Lens 17 Landscape mode 45 Language 105 Lens specifications 122 M Mounting/dismounting the lens 21 Manual focus 33 Manual mode 43 Multi AF 61 MF Assist 63 Multi-metering 67126 Mac users 96 Memory card 112 N Night mode 45 Noise reduction 53 O Option/menu selection method 26 OIS 35 P Program mode 40 Portrait mode 45 P Wiz BKT 73 Picture wizard 75 Playback 79 Picture editing 87 Picture style 88 Print info 89 Photo printer 102 PictBridge 102 Power save 107 Q Quality 52 Quickview 105 R Recording a movie 48 Resolution 51 Red-eye reduction 56 Rotating 87 Red-eye fix 88 Regular TV 91 RAW 101 Reset 106 S Shooting mode 5 Subject 7 Status lamp 16 Strap 22 Sound 29 Screen display 30 Smart Auto mode 39 Shutter Priority mode 42 Shutter speed 42 Scene mode 46 Setting the flash option 55 Single AF 60 Selection AF 61 Self-portrait face detection 65 Spot metering 67 Smart range 72 Shooting method 73 Smart album 81 Slide show 84 Samsung Raw Converter 99 System volume 105 T Title and role of each part 14 Turning on the power 23 Tips 32 Timer 54 Thumbnail view 81 U Unpacking 13 Using the dial 26 User display 29 V View a movie 85 Video Out 108 W Wind Cut 49 White balance 68 Windows users 93 WB BKT 73 Z Zoom 34 1st Curtain 58 2nd Curtain 58 IndexCorrect Disposal of This Product (Waste Electrical & Electronic Equipment) (Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate collection systems) This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these items from other types of waste and recycle them responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources. Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take these items for environmentally safe recycling. Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its electronic accessories should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal. Correct disposal of batteries in this product (Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate battery return systems) This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that the batteries in this product should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of their working life. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium or lead above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to human health or the environment. To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them through your local, free battery return system. This Class [B] digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. Planet First Planet First represents Samsung Electronics' commitment to the sustainable development and social responsibility through eco-driven business and management activities.Please refer to the warranty that came with your product or visit our website http://www.samsungimaging.com for after-sales service or inquiries. I9105P www.samsung.com Consultez le mode d’emploi complet de votre appareil pour obtenir davantage d’informations. Pour savoir comment accéder au mode d’emploi, reportez-vous à la section « Afficher le mode d’emploi » du présent Guide de prise en main rapide. Guide de prise en main rapide2 www.sar-tick.com Ce produit est conforme aux limites nationales DAS (Débit d’Absorption Spécifique) fixées à une valeur maximale de 2,0 W/kg. Les valeurs DAS maximales sont indiquées à la section Informations sur la certification DAS de ce Guide de prise en main rapide. Lorsque vous transportez ce produit ou lorsque vous l’utilisez près du corps, portez-le à une distance d’au moins 1,5 cm de votre corps afin de respecter les exigences en matière de radiofréquences. Cet appareil vous permet de communiquer et d’accéder à des divertissements de haute qualité, basés sur les critères de qualité et la technologie de Samsung. • Le contenu de ce guide de prise en main rapide peut différer par rapport au produit ou à votre version logicielle, et faire l’objet de modifications sans préavis. • Les éléments fournis avec l’appareil et les accessoires disponibles peuvent varier en fonction de votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur.3 • Les accessoires fournis ont été spécifiquement conçus pour cet appareil et peuvent ne pas fonctionner avec d’autres appareils. • Vous pouvez acheter d’autres accessoires auprès de votre revendeur Samsung. Avant tout achat, assurez-vous qu’ils sont compatibles avec votre appareil. • Certains accessoires, autres que ceux fournis, peuvent ne pas être compatibles avec votre appareil. • Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable des problèmes de performance ou des incompatibilités découlant de la modification des paramètres de registre par l’utilisateur. Toute tentative de personnalisation du système d’exploitation peut entraîner des problèmes de fonctionnement de votre appareil ou de ses applications.4 Icônes Avertissement : situations susceptibles de vous blesser ou de blesser autrui. Attention : situations susceptibles d’endommager votre appareil ou d’autres équipements. Remarque : remarques, conseils d’utilisation ou informations complémentaires. Droits d’auteur Copyright © 2013 Samsung Electronics Ce mode d’emploi est protégé par les lois internationales sur les droits d’auteur. Il est interdit de reproduire, distribuer, traduire ou transmettre sous quelque forme et par quelque moyen que ce soit, électronique ou mécanique, notamment par photocopie, enregistrement ou stockage dans un système de stockage et de recherche documentaire, tout ou partie de ce document, sans le consentement préalable écrit de Samsung Electronics.5 Marques • SAMSUNG et le logo SAMSUNG sont des marques déposées de Samsung Electronics. • Les logos Android, Google ™, Google Maps ™, Google Mail ™, YouTube ™, Google Play ™ Store et Google Talk ™ sont des marques de Google, Inc. • Bluetooth® est une marque déposée de Bluetooth SIG, Inc. • Wi-Fi ®, Wi-Fi Protected Setup ™, Wi-Fi Direct ™, Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ et le logo Wi-Fi sont des marques déposées de Wi-Fi Alliance. Votre appareil utilise une fréquence non harmonisée. Il est conçu pour fonctionner dans tous les pays européens. Au sein de l’Union Européenne, le réseau Wi-Fi peut fonctionner sans restriction en intérieur, mais pas en extérieur. • Toutes les autres marques et droits d’auteur demeurent la propriété de leurs propriétaires respectifs.6 Démarrage Présentation de l’appareil Touche Retour Microphone Capteur de proximité/ luminosité Connecteur à fonctions multiples Microphone pour haut-parleur Touche Menu Écouteur Écran tactile Touche Accueil Touche de volume Objectif avant7 Démarrage Prise audio 3,5 mm Objectif arrière Haut-parleur Antenne GPS Flash Touche Marche/Arrêt Antenne principale Cache arrière Ne couvrez pas la zone autour de l’antenne avec vos mains ou tout autre objet. Cela pourrait entraîner des problèmes de connectivité ou décharger la batterie.8 Démarrage Touches Touche Fonction Marche/ Arrêt • Maintenir cette touche enfoncée pour allumer ou éteindre l’appareil. • Maintenir cette touche enfoncée pendant 8 à 10 secondes pour réinitialiser l’appareil en cas d’erreur fatale, ou s’il ne répond plus ou mal. • Appuyer sur cette touche pour verrouiller ou déverrouiller l’appareil. Lorsque l’écran s’éteint, l’appareil passe en mode Verrouillage. Menu • Appuyer sur cette touche pour ouvrir la liste des options disponibles dans l’écran actuel. • Depuis l’écran d’accueil, maintenir cette touche enfoncée pour lancer l’application de recherche Google. Accueil • Appuyer sur cette touche pour revenir à l’écran d’accueil. • Maintenir cette touche enfoncée pour ouvrir la liste des applications récentes. Retour • Appuyer sur cette touche pour revenir à l’écran précédent.9 Démarrage Touche Fonction Volume • Appuyer sur cette touche pour régler le volume de l’appareil. Installer la carte SIM ou USIM et la batterie Insérez la carte SIM ou USIM fournie par votre opérateur, ainsi que la batterie. 1 Retirez le cache arrière. Veillez à ne pas abîmer vos ongles en retirant le cache arrière.10 Démarrage 2 Insérez la carte SIM ou USIM, puce orientée vers le bas. Le compartiment pour carte SIM de votre appareil ne convient qu’aux cartes SIM. Insérer une carte microSIM avec un support inadapté peut endommager le compartiment pour carte SIM de votre appareil. 3 Insérez la batterie. 2 111 Démarrage 4 Remettez le cache arrière en place. 1 2 Charger la batterie Vous devez charger la batterie avant d’utiliser l’appareil pour la première fois lorsque vous ne l’avez pas utilisé depuis un certain temps. Utilisez uniquement des chargeurs, des batteries et des câbles de connexion PC homologués par Samsung. L’utilisation de chargeurs ou de câbles non homologués peut provoquer l’éclatement de la batterie ou endommager l’appareil.12 Démarrage Branchez la fiche micro-USB du chargeur sur le connecteur à fonctions multiples de l’appareil et l’autre extrémité sur une prise de courant. Un branchement incorrect du chargeur peut sérieusement endommager l’appareil. Les dégâts résultant d’une mauvaise utilisation ne sont pas couverts par la garantie. Lorsque la batterie est complètement chargée, déconnectez l'appareil du chargeur. Pour ce faire, débranchez d’abord le chargeur de l’appareil, puis de la prise de courant. Ne retirez jamais la batterie avant d’avoir débranché le chargeur. Ceci pourrait endommager l’appareil. Pour économiser l’énergie, débranchez le chargeur lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas. Le chargeur n’étant pas muni d’un bouton Marche/Arrêt, vous devez le débrancher de la prise de courant pour couper l’alimentation. L’appareil doit rester à proximité de la prise en cours de chargement.13 Démarrage Vérifier la charge de la batterie Lorsque vous chargez la batterie et que l’appareil est éteint, les icônes suivantes indiquent l’état du chargement : Chargement en cours Chargement terminé Allumer et éteindre l’appareil Si vous allumez l’appareil pour la première fois, suivez les instructions affichées à l’écran pour procéder à sa configuration. Pour allumer et éteindre l’appareil, maintenez la touche Marche/Arrêt enfoncée pendant quelques secondes.14 Fonctions de base Notifications Des icônes de notification peuvent apparaître dans le volet des raccourcis afin de vous signaler les appels manqués, les nouveaux messages, les événements à venir, le statut de l’appareil, et plus encore. Ouvrez le volet des raccourcis, puis affichez le statut de l'appareil, ainsi que les options disponibles. Pour ouvrir le volet des raccourcis, faites glisser la barre d’état de haut en bas. Pour fermer le volet des raccourcis, faites glisser la barre d’état de bas en haut. La disponibilité des options dépend de votre zone géographique ou de votre opérateur.15 Fonctions de base Passer un appel ou y répondre Découvrez comment utiliser les fonctions d’appel de votre appareil : passer un appel, répondre à un appel, utiliser les options disponibles en cours d’appel ou personnaliser les autres fonctions. Passer un appel Composez le numéro à l’aide du clavier, puis appuyez sur . Répondre à un appel Lorsque vous recevez un appel, faites glisser votre doigt sur l’icône . Gérer les contacts Pour tous vos contacts, vous pouvez enregistrer des numéros de téléphone, des adresses e-mail, et plus encore. Vous pouvez créer des groupes de contacts et également envoyer leurs coordonnées à d’autres personnes ou les partager.16 Fonctions de base Envoyer des messages Vous pouvez envoyer des messages texte (SMS) ou multimédia (MMS). L’envoi ou la réception de messages en dehors de la zone couverte par votre opérateur peut occasionner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l’offre à laquelle vous avez souscrite. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. Utiliser les applications La liste des applications affiche les icônes de toutes vos applications, y compris celles récemment installées. Pour ouvrir une application, ouvrez la liste des applications et appuyez sur l’icône correspondante. Appuyez sur pour fermer les applications.17 Fonctions de base Accéder à Internet Connectez-vous à Internet à l’aide de la fonction Wi-Fi ou de votre connexion de données. Ouvrez l’application Internet et naviguez sur les pages Web. L’accès au Web et le téléchargement de contenu multimédia peuvent entraîner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l’offre souscrite auprès de votre opérateur. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. Utiliser la fonction NFC Votre appareil est équipé d’une fonction qui permet de lire les tags NFC (Near Field Communication) contenant des informations relatives aux produits. Grâce à cette fonction, vous pouvez également effectuer des paiements et acheter des tickets de transport ou de spectacle après avoir téléchargé les applications correspondantes. La batterie comporte une antenne NFC intégrée. Manipulez-la avec précaution afin de ne pas endommager l’antenne NFC.18 Fonctions de base Afficher le mode d’emploi Le mode d’emploi vous fournit des informations complètes sur le fonctionnement de votre appareil. L’accès au Web et le téléchargement de contenu multimédia peuvent entraîner des frais supplémentaires, en fonction de l’offre souscrite auprès de votre opérateur. Pour en savoir plus, contactez votre opérateur. À partir de votre appareil 1 Ouvrez l’application Internet. 2 Appuyez sur pour ouvrir la liste des favoris. 3 Sélectionnez le favori correspondant au mode d’emploi. Pour accéder plus facilement au mode d’emploi, placez un raccourci vers le mode d’emploi sur l’écran d’accueil. Selon votre navigateur ou votre opérateur, le mode d’emploi peut ne pas être disponible dans les favoris. À partir de l’ordinateur Accédez au site www.samsung.com, puis recherchez le mode d’emploi à l’aide du nom de modèle de votre appareil.19 Consignes de sécurité Ces consignes de sécurité concernent l’ensemble des appareils mobiles. Il est possible qu’elles ne soient pas toutes applicables à votre appareil. Avant d’utiliser cet appareil, lisez les consignes de sécurité afin d’éviter de vous blesser ou de blesser autrui, ou d’endommager l’appareil. Avertissement: évitez les décharges électriques, le feu et les explosions N’utilisez pas de prises et de cordons d’alimentation endommagé(e)s ou de prises électriques mal fixées Ne touchez pas le cordon d’alimentation avec les mains mouillées ou ne déconnectez pas le chargeur en tirant sur le cordon Ne tordez pas ou n’endommagez pas le cordon d’alimentation N’utilisez pas votre appareil avec les mains mouillées ou lorsque celui-ci est en cours de chargement Ne provoquez pas de court-circuit avec le chargeur ou l’appareil Ne laissez pas tomber le chargeur ou l’appareil et ne les exposez pas aux chocs Ne rechargez pas la batterie avec un chargeur non approuvé par le fabricant N’utilisez pas votre appareil pendant un orage L’appareil peut mal fonctionner et les risques de décharge électrique peuvent augmenter. Ne manipulez pas la batterie Lithium Ion (Li-Ion) lorsque celle-ci coule ou est endommagée Pour une mise au rebut en toute sécurité de la batterie Li-Ion, contactez le centre de service après-vente le plus proche de chez vous.20 Consignes de sécurité Manipulez et jetez l’appareil et le chargeur avec précaution • Utilisez exclusivement une batterie et un chargeur homologués par Samsung et spécialement conçus pour votre appareil. L’utilisation d’une batterie et d’un chargeur incompatibles peut provoquer des blessures graves ou endommager votre appareil. • Ne jetez jamais la batterie ou l’appareil au feu. Respectez la réglementation en vigueur dans votre pays concernant la mise au rebut des batteries ou des appareils usagés. • Ne posez jamais la batterie ou l’appareil à l’intérieur ou au-dessus d’appareils chauffants, tels que des fours à micro-ondes, des cuisinières ou des radiateurs. En cas de surchauffe, ils pourraient exploser. • N’écrasez ou ne perforez jamais l’appareil. Évitez d’exposer l’appareil à une pression externe élevée qui risquerait d’entraîner un court-circuit interne et une surchauffe. Protégez l’appareil, la batterie et le chargeur de tout dommage • Évitez d’exposer l’appareil et la batterie à des températures très basses ou très élevées. • Ne soumettez pas l’appareil à des températures extrêmes, car cela pourrait l’endommager, ou réduire la capacité de chargement et la durée de vie de l’appareil et de la batterie. • Évitez que la batterie entrent en contact avec des objets métalliques, car cela risquerait de provoquer un court-circuit entre les bornes + et – de la batterie et de l’endommager de manière temporaire ou permanente. • N’utilisez jamais une batterie ou un chargeur endommagé(e). Attention: respectez tous les avertissements de sécurité et les réglementations en vigueur lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil dans un endroit où son utilisation est réglementée N’utilisez pas votre appareil à proximité d’autres appareils électroniques La plupart des appareils électroniques utilisent des signaux de radiofréquence. Il est possible que votre appareil cause des interférences avec d’autres appareils électroniques.21 Consignes de sécurité N’utilisez pas votre appareil à proximité d’un stimulateur cardiaque • Maintenez une distance minimale de 15 cm entre votre appareil et un stimulateur cardiaque pour éviter toute interférence. • Pour minimiser les risques d’interférence avec un stimulateur cardiaque, utilisez l’appareil sur le côté opposé à l’implant. N’utilisez pas votre appareil dans un hôpital ou à proximité d’équipements médicaux en raison des interférences qu’il pourrait produire Si vous utilisez un équipement médical, contactez son fabricant avant d’utiliser votre appareil afin de vous assurer que votre équipement ne sera pas affecté par les radiofréquences émises par l’appareil. Si vous utilisez une prothèse auditive, contactez votre fabriquant afin d’obtenir plus d’informations sur les interférences Les radiofréquences émises par votre appareil peuvent causer des interférences avec certaines prothèses auditives. Avant d’utiliser votre appareil, contactez le fabricant de la prothèse afin de vous assurer que son fonctionnement ne sera pas altéré par les radiofréquences émises par l’appareil. Éteignez l’appareil dans les lieux présentant des risques d’explosion • Éteignez l’appareil dans les lieux présentant des risques d’explosion. • Respectez toujours les consignes, les instructions et la signalétique d’utilisation dans un environnement explosif. • N’utilisez pas votre appareil dans des zones de ravitaillement en carburant (station-service), à proximité d’usines chimiques ou dans des zones de dynamitage. • Ne transportez et ne stockez jamais de liquides inflammables, de gaz ou de matériaux explosifs dans le même habitacle que l’appareil, ses composants ou ses accessoires. Éteignez votre appareil lorsque vous vous trouvez dans un avion Votre appareil peut provoquer des interférences avec les instruments de navigation électroniques.22 Consignes de sécurité Votre appareil peut provoquer des interférences avec les équipement automobiles Les équipements électroniques à bord de votre véhicule peuvent présenter des dysfonctionnements en raison des interférences radio émises par votre appareil. Contactez le constructeur pour obtenir plus d’informations. Respectez toutes les consignes de sécurité et réglementations relatives à l’utilisation de votre appareil lorsque vous vous trouvez au volant d’un véhicule Votre responsabilité principale est avant tout de conduire votre véhicule sans prendre de risques. N’utilisez jamais votre appareil au volant, si cela est interdit par la loi. Pour votre propre sécurité et celle d’autrui, faites preuve de bon sens et gardez à l’esprit les conseils suivants : • Apprenez à connaître les fonctions pratiques de votre appareil, comme par exemple la numérotation rapide et la fonction de rappel automatique. Ces fonctions vous permettent de gagner du temps et de rester concentré lorsque vous passez ou recevez des appels sur votre appareil. • Gardez votre appareil à portée de main. Assurez-vous de pouvoir atteindre votre appareil mobile sans quitter la route des yeux. Si vous recevez un appel entrant à un moment inopportun, laissez votre messagerie vocale répondre à votre place. • Interrompez tout appel en cas d’embouteillages ou de conditions météorologiques dangereuses. La pluie, la neige, le verglas et une circulation dense sont des facteurs dangereux. • Ne prenez pas de notes ou ne recherchez pas de numéros de téléphone. Noter une liste de tâches à effectuer ou parcourir votre répertoire détourne votre attention de votre responsabilité principale qui consiste à conduire sans prendre de risques. • Composez des numéros de manière raisonnable et évaluez l’état de la circulation. Passez vos appels lorsque vous êtes immobilisé ou avant de vous insérer dans la circulation. Essayez de passer vos appels de préférence lorsque votre véhicule est stationné.23 Consignes de sécurité • Ne poursuivez pas de conversations stressantes ou émotionnelles qui pourraient vous distraire. Informez vos interlocuteurs que vous êtes au volant et interrompez toute conversation susceptible d’altérer votre attention sur la route. • Utilisez votre appareil pour demander de l’aide. En cas d’incendie, d’accident de la route ou d’urgence médicale, composez le numéro d’urgence local. • Utilisez votre appareil pour aider d’autres personnes en situation d’urgence. Si vous êtes témoin d’un accident, d’une agression ou de toute autre situation d’urgence mettant des vies en jeu, contactez les services d’urgence locaux. • Appelez un service d’assistance dépannage ou un service spécial d’assistance, si cela s’avère nécessaire. Si vous croisez un véhicule endommagé ne présentant pas de danger immédiat, si vous constatez un feu rouge cassé, un accident de la route sans gravité où personne ne semble blessé ou encore un véhicule que vous savez volé, appelez un service d’assistance dépannage ou un service spécial d’assistance autre que les services d’urgence. Pour entretenir et bien utiliser votre appareil Conservez votre appareil au sec • L’humidité et les liquides peuvent endommager les pièces ou les circuits électroniques de votre appareil. • N’allumez pas votre appareil s’il présente des marques d’humidité. Si votre appareil est déjà allumé, éteignez-le, puis retirez immédiatement la batterie (si vous n’arrivez pas à l’éteindre ou à retirer la batterie, laissez votre appareil tel quel). Essuyez-le ensuite à l’aide d’une serviette et confiez-le à un centre de service après-vente Samsung. • Les liquides modifient la couleur de l’étiquette indiquant que l’intérieur de l’appareil a été endommagé. L’eau peut endommager votre appareil et entraîner l’annulation de la garantie du fabricant.24 Consignes de sécurité Cet appareil ne doit pas être utilisé ou stocké dans des zones où la concentration de poussières ou de microparticules en suspension dans l’atmosphère est élevée La poussière ou les microparticules peuvent provoquer des dysfonctionnements de l’appareil et entraîner des incendies ou des chocs électriques. Posez toujours votre appareil sur des surfaces planes Si votre appareil tombe, il peut être endommagé. N’entreposez pas votre appareil dans des endroits extrêmement chauds ou froids. Il est recommandé d’utiliser cet appareil à des températures comprises entre 5 °C et 35 °C • Votre appareil peut exploser si vous le laissez dans un véhicule fermé, la température intérieure pouvant monter jusqu’à 80 °C. • N’exposez pas votre appareil à la lumière directe du soleil de manière prolongée (comme par exemple sur le tableau de bord d’une voiture). • Conservez la batterie à des températures comprises entre 0 °C et 45 °C. N’entreposez pas votre appareil à proximité d’objets métalliques, comme par exemple des pièces, des clés ou des colliers • Votre appareil pourrait être rayé ou subir des dysfonctionnements. • Les bornes de la batterie peuvent causer des incendies si elles sont mises en contact avec des objets métalliques. Ne conservez pas votre appareil à proximité de champs magnétiques • Lorsqu’il est exposé à des champs magnétiques, votre appareil peut subir des dysfonctionnements ou la batterie peut se décharger. • Les cartes à piste, comme par exemple les cartes de crédit, les cartes de téléphone et les cartes d’embarquement peuvent être endommagées par les champs magnétiques. • N’utilisez pas de housses ou d’accessoires équipés de fermetures aimantées et évitez toute exposition prolongée de votre appareil à des champs magnétiques.25 Consignes de sécurité Ne conservez pas votre appareil à proximité ou à l’intérieur de radiateurs, de fours à micro-ondes, d’équipements de cuisine chauffants ou de conteneurs à haute pression • La batterie peut couler. • Votre appareil peut surchauffer et causer un incendie. Ne laissez pas tomber votre appareil et ne l’exposez pas aux chocs • L’écran de votre appareil pourrait être endommagé. • Votre appareil peut être endommagé ou certaines pièces peuvent subir des dysfonctionnements si vous le tordez ou le déformez. En cas de surchauffe de l’appareil, n’utilisez pas ce dernier ainsi que ses applications pendant quelques temps Un contact prolongé de votre peau avec un appareil en surchauffe peut entraîner des symptômes de brûlure faible, tels que des points rouges et de pigmentation. Si l’appareil photo de votre appareil est équipé d’un flash, ne l’utilisez pas à proximité des yeux des personnes ou des animaux Utiliser un flash à proximité des yeux peut causer des lésions oculaires ou une perte temporaire de la vue. Prenez des précautions lorsque vous êtes exposé aux lumières artificielles • Lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil, ne laissez pas la pièce dans laquelle vous vous trouvez dans l’obscurité et ne rapprochez pas trop l’écran de vos yeux. • L’exposition à la luminosité de l’écran lors du visionnage prolongé de vidéos ou de jeux peut entraîner des malaises. En cas de sensations d’inconfort, cessez immédiatement d’utiliser l’appareil.26 Consignes de sécurité Réduisez les risques de lésions musculaires dus aux mouvements répétitifs Lorsque vous effectuez des actions répétitives, comme taper sur les touches, dessiner des caractères sur un écran tactile ou jouer à des jeux, vous pouvez ressentir une sensation d’inconfort au niveau des mains, de la nuque, des épaules ou de toute autre partie du corps. Si vous utilisez votre appareil sur des périodes prolongées, tenez-le sans trop le serrer, appuyez doucement sur les touches et faites des pauses fréquentes. En cas de sensations d’inconfort, cessez immédiatement d’utiliser l’appareil et consultez un médecin. Préservez la durée de vie de la batterie et du chargeur • Évitez de laisser l’appareil en charge pendant plus d’une semaine, car une surcharge pourrait réduire la durée de vie de la batterie. • Lorsqu’il n’est pas utilisé pendant une durée prolongée, votre appareil se décharge progressivement et devra être rechargé avant toute utilisation. • Débranchez le chargeur de la prise secteur lorsque vous ne l’utilisez pas. • Utilisez uniquement la batterie dans le cadre de l’utilisation prévue. Utilisez des batteries, des chargeurs, des accessoires et des fournitures homologués • L’utilisation d’une batterie ou d’un chargeur générique peut réduire la durée de vie de votre appareil ou provoquer des dysfonctionnements. • Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable de la sécurité de l’utilisateur si celui-ci utilise des accessoires ou des éléments non homologués par Samsung. Ne mordez et ne portez pas à votre bouche l’appareil ou la batterie • Vous pourriez endommager l’appareil ou provoquer une explosion. • Assurez-vous que les enfants manipulent l’appareil de façon appropriée s’ils doivent l’utiliser. Ne mettez pas votre appareil ou ses accessoires dans vos yeux, vos oreilles ou votre bouche Vous pourriez vous étouffer ou vous blesser gravement.27 Consignes de sécurité Lorsque vous utilisez l’appareil : • Tenez l’appareil droit, comme vous le feriez avec un téléphone traditionnel. • Parlez directement dans le microphone. • Ne touchez pas l’antenne interne de l’appareil. Cela pourrait entraîner une dégradation de la qualité de l’appel ou provoquer l’émission de niveaux de radiofréquences (RF) inattendus. Protégez votre oreille lorsque vous utilisez un casque ou des écouteurs • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé peut endommager votre audition. • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé lorsque vous êtes au volant peut détourner votre attention et provoquer un accident. • Diminuez toujours le volume avant de connecter des écouteurs à une source audio et réglez le volume minimum nécessaire vous permettant d’entendre votre conversation ou la musique. • Dans les environnements secs, les casques et écouteurs sont propices à la formation d’électricité statique. Évitez alors d’utiliser votre casque ou vos écouteurs et touchez un objet métallique pour vous décharger de toute électricité statique avant de brancher le casque/les écouteurs sur l’appareil. Restez prudent lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil en marchant ou en bougeant • Restez toujours conscient de votre environnement afin d’éviter de vous blesser ou de blesser d’autres personnes. • Assurez-vous de ne pas accrocher le cordon du casque avec vos bras ou avec des objets à proximité.28 Consignes de sécurité Ne placez pas votre appareil dans vos poches arrières ou à votre ceinture Vous pourriez vous blesser ou endommager votre appareil en cas de chute. Ne démontez pas, ne modifiez pas ou ne réparez pas vous-même votre appareil • Toute modification ou tout changement effectué(e) sur votre appareil peut entraîner l’annulation de la garantie du fabricant. Si votre appareil doit être réparé, confiez-le à un service après-vente Samsung. • Ne démontez pas ou ne perforez pas la batterie, car ceci peut causer une explosion ou un incendie. Ne peignez jamais votre appareil et n’y apposez jamais d’autocollants La peinture et les autocollants risquent de bloquer les pièces mobiles de l’appareil et perturber son fonctionnement. Si vous êtes allergique à la peinture ou aux pièces métalliques de l’appareil, vous pouvez souffrir de démangeaisons, d’eczéma ou de toute autre réaction cutanée. Si ces symptômes apparaissent, cessez immédiatement d’utiliser l’appareil et consultez un médecin. Pour nettoyer votre appareil: • Essuyez votre appareil ou le chargeur avec un chiffon ou une gomme. • Nettoyez les bornes de la batterie avec un morceau de coton ou un chiffon. • N’utilisez pas de produits chimiques ou de détergents. N’utilisez pas l’appareil si son écran est fissuré ou cassé Le verre ou l’acrylique brisé risque de vous blesser à la main ou au visage. Confiez votre appareil à un service après-vente Samsung afin de le faire réparer. Utilisez votre appareil uniquement pour vous servir des fonctions auxquelles il est destiné Évitez de déranger votre entourage lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil dans un lieu public Ne laissez pas les enfants utiliser votre appareil Cet appareil n’est pas un jouet. Ne laissez pas les enfants jouer avec, car ils pourraient se blesser ou blesser autrui, et endommager l’appareil.29 Consignes de sécurité Installez l’appareil et ses accessoires avec précaution • Veillez à la bonne fixation de votre appareil mobile et de ses accessoires dans votre véhicule. • Évitez de placer votre appareil ou ses accessoires à proximité de la zone de déploiement des airbags. Si l’équipement mobile n’est pas installé correctement, le déclenchement de l’airbag risque de provoquer des blessures graves. Toute réparation doit être réalisée par un technicien agréé Le recours aux services d’un technicien non agréé risque d’entraîner des dégâts sur l’appareil et d’annuler la garantie du fabricant. Manipulez les cartes SIM et les cartes mémoire avec soin • Ne retirez pas une carte lorsque l’appareil y enregistre ou y lit des informations, car vous risqueriez de perdre des données et/ou d’endommager la carte ou l’appareil lui-même. • Protégez les cartes contre les chocs violents, les décharges électrostatiques et les interférences émises par d’autres appareils. • Ne touchez pas les contacts dorés de la carte avec vos doigts ou avec des objets métalliques. Si la carte est sale, nettoyez-la avec un chiffon doux. Assurez l’accès aux services d’urgence Dans certaines zones ou dans certaines circonstances, il peut être impossible de joindre les numéros d’urgence avec votre appareil. Avant de vous rendre dans des régions isolées ou non couvertes, prévoyez un autre moyen pour contacter les services d’urgence. Protégez vos données importantes • Lorsque vous utilisez votre appareil, assurez-vous de sauvegarder vos données importantes. Samsung ne peut être tenu responsable de la perte de données. • Lors de la mise au rebut de votre appareil, sauvegardez l’ensemble de vos données, puis réinitialisez votre appareil afin d’éviter tout usage abusif de vos données personnelles. • Veuillez lire attentivement les données d’autorisation lors du téléchargement d’applications. Soyez particulièrement vigilant lors de l’utilisation d’applications ayant accès à de nombreuses fonctions ou à un volume important de données personnelles.30 Consignes de sécurité • Vérifiez régulièrement vos comptes afin de détecter toute utilisation non autorisée ou suspecte. Si vous identifiez des signes indiquant un usage abusif de vos informations personnelles, contactez votre opérateur pour supprimer ou modifier les informations relatives à votre compte. • Si vous avez perdu votre appareil ou s’il vous a été volé, modifiez les mots de passe de vos comptes afin de protéger vos informations personnelles. • Évitez d’utiliser des applications provenant de sources inconnues et verrouillez votre appareil à l’aide d’un modèle, d’un mot de passe ou d’un code PIN. Ne transmettez pas d’éléments protégés par des droits d’auteur Ne transmettez pas d’éléments protégés par des droits d’auteur sans la permission des détenteurs de ces droits. Dans le cas contraire, vous seriez en infraction avec la législation sur les droits d’auteur. Le fabricant n’est en aucun cas responsable de l’utilisation frauduleuse des éléments protégés par les droits d’auteur. Informations sur la certification DAS CET APPAREIL MOBILE EST CONFORME AUX DIRECTIVES INTERNATIONALES SUR L’EXPOSITION AUX RADIOFRÉQUENCES Cet appareil mobile est un émetteur-récepteur radio. Il a été conçu pour ne pas dépasser les limites d’exposition aux radiofréquences (RF) recommandées par les directives internationales et en vigueur en France. Ces directives, développées par un organisme scientifique indépendant (ICNIRP), tiennent compte d’une marge importante de sécurité permettant d’assurer la sécurité des personnes, quels que soient leur âge et leur état de santé. La valeur utilisée dans le cadre de ces directives est le DAS, ou débit d’absorption spécifique. Pour les appareils mobiles, la valeur DAS maximale autorisée est de 2,0 watts par kilogramme (W/Kg). Le DAS est mesuré en utilisant l’appareil mobile dans des conditions de fonctionnement standard et en balayant l’ensemble des fréquences. Valeurs DAS maximales pour ce modèle, conformément aux directives ICNIRP :31 Consignes de sécurité Valeurs DAS maximales pour ce modèle DAS au niveau de la tête 0,327 W/Kg DAS au niveau du corps 0,326 W/Kg Lorsque l’appareil est en fonctionnement, le niveau de DAS réel de cet appareil est généralement beaucoup plus faible que les valeurs indiquées ci-dessus. En effet, pour des raisons d’efficacité du système et pour réduire les interférences au niveau du réseau, la puissance utile de votre appareil mobile est automatiquement réduite lorsque la transmission du signal ne nécessite pas une pleine puissance. Des essais DAS ont été réalisés avec ce produit porté à une distance de 1,5 cm du corps. Afin de respecter les exigences en matière d’exposition aux radiofréquences, cet appareil doit être positionné à une distance de 1,5 cm du corps. Cependant, quelques dispositions simples peuvent contribuer à diminuer le niveau d’exposition aux radiofréquences. Ainsi, afin de réduire au maximum la puissance d’émission de votre appareil mobile, veillez à l’utiliser dans des conditions de réception optimales, l’indicateur de puissance du signal affiché à l’écran comportant alors un nombre suffisant de barres. En général, plus vous êtes proche d’un relais, plus la puissance utilisée par l’appareil mobile est faible. Les informations scientifiques actuelles n’indiquent en rien que l’utilisation des appareils mobiles exige de prendre de quelconques précautions spéciales. Cependant, des organismes tels que l’Organisation Mondiale de la Santé et la Food and Drug Administration recommandent aux personnes souhaitant minimiser leur exposition aux radiofréquences de réduire la durée d’utilisation de l’appareil ou d’utiliser autant que possible un kit mains-libres permettant d’éloigner l’appareil mobile de leur tête et de leur corps durant son utilisation. Cependant, on veillera dans ce cas à éloigner le téléphone du ventre des femmes enceintes et du bas ventre des enfants et des adolescents. Pour plus d’informations, visitez le site www.samsung.com/sar et recherchez votre appareil à l’aide du numéro de modèle.32 Consignes de sécurité Les bons gestes de mise au rebut de ce produit (Déchets d’équipements électriques et électroniques) (Applicable aux pays disposant de systèmes de collecte séparés) Ce symbole sur le produit, ses accessoires ou sa documentation indique que ni le produit, ni ses accessoires électroniques usagés (chargeur, casque audio, câble de connexion, etc.), ne peuvent être jetés avec les autres déchets ménagers. La mise au rebut incontrôlée des déchets présentant des risques environnementaux et de santé publique, veuillez séparer vos produits et accessoires usagés des autres déchets. Vous favoriserez ainsi le recyclage de la matière qui les compose dans le cadre d’un développement durable. Les particuliers sont invités à contacter le magasin leur ayant vendu le produit ou à se renseigner auprès des autorités locales pour connaître les procédures et les points de collecte de ces produits en vue de leur recyclage. Les entreprises et professionnels sont invités à contacter leurs fournisseurs et à consulter les conditions de leur contrat de vente. Ce produit et ses accessoires ne peuvent être jetés avec les autres déchets professionnels et commerciaux.33 Consignes de sécurité Élimination de la batterie de ce produit (Applicable aux pays disposant de systèmes de collecte séparés) Le symbole sur la batterie, le manuel ou l’emballage indique que la batterie de ce produit ne doit pas être éliminée en fin de vie avec les autres déchets ménagers. L’indication éventuelle des symboles chimiques Hg, Cd ou Pb signifie que la batterie contient des quantités de mercure, de cadmium ou de plomb supérieures aux niveaux de référence stipulés dans la directive CE 2006/66. Si la batterie n’est pas correctement éliminée, ces substances peuvent porter préjudice à la santé humaine ou à l’environnement. Afin de protéger les ressources naturelles et d’encourager la réutilisation du matériel, veillez à séparer la batterie des autres types de déchets et à la recycler via votre système local de collecte gratuite des piles et batteries. Limitation de responsabilité Les contenus et les services accessibles par l’intermédiaire de cet appareil appartiennent dans leur intégralité à des tiers et sont protégés par les lois sur les droits d’auteur, les brevets, les marques et/ou d’autres lois sur la propriété intellectuelle. Ces contenus et services sont fournis uniquement pour votre usage personnel et non pour une utilisation commerciale. Vous ne pouvez pas utiliser ces contenus ou services d’une manière qui n’a pas été autorisée par le propriétaire des contenus ou le fournisseur des services. Sans que cela ne limite ce qui précède, sauf autorisation expresse du propriétaire de contenus ou du fournisseur de services concerné, il vous est interdit de modifier, de copier, de republier, de transférer, de diffuser, de transmettre, de traduire, de vendre, d’exploiter ou de distribuer, d’une quelconque manière et sur quelque support que ce soit, des contenus ou des services affichés par l’intermédiaire de cet appareil ou d’en créer des dérivés.34 Consignes de sécurité LES CONTENUS ET SERVICES DE TIERS SONT FOURNIS “ EN L’ÉTAT “. DANS TOUTE LA MESURE PERMISE PAR LA LOI LOCALE, SAMSUNG NE GARANTIT PAS LES CONTENUS OU LES SERVICES AINSI FOURNIS, EXPRESSÉMENT OU IMPLICITEMENT, À QUELQUE FIN QUE CE SOIT. SAMSUNG EXCLUT EXPRESSÉMENT TOUTE GARANTIE IMPLICITE, Y COMPRIS, SANS QUE CELA SOIT LIMITATIF, LES GARANTIES DE QUALITÉ MARCHANDE ET D’ADÉQUATION À UN USAGE PARTICULIER. SAMSUNG NE GARANTIT PAS L’EXACTITUDE, LA VALIDITÉ, L’ACTUALITÉ, LA LÉGALITÉ OU L’EXHAUSTIVITÉ DES CONTENUS OU DES SERVICES FOURNIS PAR L’INTERMÉDIAIRE DE CET APPAREIL, ET SAMSUNG NE SERA RESPONSABLE EN AUCUN CAS, Y COMPRIS EN CAS DE NÉGLIGENCE, QUE CE SOIT AU TITRE DE LA RESPONSABILITÉ CONTRACTUELLE OU DÉLICTUELLE, DES DOMMAGES DIRECTS, INDIRECTS, ACCESSOIRES, SPÉCIAUX OU CONSÉCUTIFS, DES HONORAIRES D’AVOCAT, DES FRAIS OU DE TOUT AUTRE DOMMAGE DÉCOULANT DE L’UTILISATION DE TOUT CONTENU OU SERVICE PAR VOUS-MÊME OU PAR UN TIERS (OU DE TOUTE INFORMATION FIGURANT DANS LEDIT CONTENU OU SERVICE), MÊME SI SAMSUNG A ÉTÉ INFORMÉ DE L’ÉVENTUALITÉ DE TELS DOMMAGES. DANS LA MESURE OÙ CERTAINS PAYS N’AUTORISENT PAS L’EXCLUSION DES GARANTIES IMPLICITES OU LA LIMITATION DES DROITS LÉGAUX DU CONSOMMATEUR, IL EST POSSIBLE QUE CES EXCLUSIONS ET LIMITATIONS NE VOUS SOIENT PAS APPLICABLES. Les services tiers peuvent être suspendus ou interrompus à tout moment, et Samsung ne garantit pas qu’un contenu ou un service restera disponible pendant une certaine période. Les contenus et les services sont transmis par des tiers au moyen de réseaux et d’équipements de transmission qui échappent au contrôle de Samsung. Sans que cela ne limite le caractère général du présent avis, Samsung décline expressément toute responsabilité en cas d’interruption ou de suspension de tout contenu ou service fourni par l’intermédiaire de cet appareil. Samsung n’est pas responsable du service client lié aux contenus et aux services. Toute question ou demande de service portant sur les contenus ou les services doit être adressée directement aux fournisseurs de contenus et de services concernés.Déclaration de conformité Informations détaillées Pour le produit suivant Produit : Appareil mobile GSM WCDMA Bluetooth/WiFi Modèle(s) : GT-I9105P Déclaration et normes applicables Nous déclarons par la présente que le produit ci-dessus est conforme aux exigences essentielles de la directive R&TTE (1999/5/CE) en application des normes suivantes : Sécurité EN 60950-1 : 2006 + A12 : 2011 DAS EN 50360 : 2001 / AC 2006 EN 62479 : 2010 EN 62311 : 2008 EN 62209 - 1 : 2006 EN 62209 - 2 : 2010 CEM EN 301 489-01 V1.9.2 (09-2011) EN 301 489-07 V1.3.1 (11-2005) EN 301 489-24 V1.5.1 (10-2010) EN 301 489-03 V1.4.1 (08-2002) EN 301 489-17 V2.1.1 (05-2009) Radio EN 301 511 V9.0.2 (03-2003) EN 301 908-2 V5.2.1 (07-2011) EN 300 328 V1.7.1 (10-2006) EN 300 440-1 V1.6.1 (08-2010) EN 302 291-1 V1.1.1 (07-2005) EN 301 908-1 V5.2.1 (05-2011) EN 301 893 V1.6.1 (11-2011) EN 300 440-2 V1.4.1 (08-2010) EN 302 291-2 V1.1.1 (07-2005) et de la directive (2011/65/UE) sur la restriction d’utilisation de certaines substances dangereuses dans un équipement électrique et électronique. La procédure de déclaration de conformité, définie dans l’article 10, puis reprise à l’alinéa [IV] de la directive 1999/5/EC a été conduite sous contrôle de l’organisme suivant : TÜV SÜD BABT, Forsyth House, Churchfield Road, Walton-on-Thames, Surrey, KT12 2TD, UK* Numéro d’identification : 0168 Représentant pour l’union européenne Samsung Electronics Euro QA Lab. Blackbushe Business Park, Saxony Way, Yateley, Hampshire, GU46 6GG, UK* 2012.11.16 Joong-Hoon Choi / Directeur de laboratoire (lieu et date de parution) (nom et signature du responsable dûment habilité) * Il ne s’agit pas de l’adresse du service après-vente de Samsung. Pour obtenir l’adresse ou le numéro de téléphone du service après-vente de Samsung, reportez-vous au certificat de garantie ou contactez le revendeur auprès duquel vous avez acheté ce produit.Printed in Korea GH68-37985A French. 01/2013. Rev. 1.0 En fonction de votre zone géographique ou votre opérateur, certains contenus peuvent différer par rapport à votre appareil. À propos de Samsung Kies Samsung Kies est un logiciel qui permet de gérer et de synchroniser vos bibliothèques multimédia et vos contacts avec des appareils Samsung. Téléchargez la dernière version de Samsung Kies à partir du site Web Samsung (www.samsung.com/kies) et installez-la sur votre ordinateur. Protégez votre oreille lorsque vous utilisez un casque ou des écouteurs • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé peut endommager votre audition. • Une exposition excessive de votre oreille à un volume élevé lorsque vous êtes au volant peut détourner votre attention et provoquer un accident. • Diminuez toujours le volume avant de connecter des écouteurs à une source audio et réglez le volume minimum nécessaire vous permettant d’entendre votre conversation ou la musique. • Dans les environnements secs, les casques et écouteurs sont propices à la formation d’électricité statique. Évitez alors d’utiliser votre casque ou vos écouteurs et touchez un objet métallique pour vous décharger de toute électricité statique avant de brancher le casque/les écouteurs sur l’appareil. SCX-3200 Series Multi-Functional Mono Printer User’s Guide imagine the possibilities Thank you for purchasing a Samsung product. Copyright_ 2 copyright © 2010 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. All rights reserved. This user’s guide is provided for information purposes only. All information included herein is subject to change without notice. Samsung Electronics is not responsible for any direct or indirect damages, arising from or related to use of this user’s guide. • Samsung and the Samsung logo are trademarks of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. • PCL and PCL 6 are trademarks fo Hewlett-Packard Company. • Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Windows 7, and Windows Server 2008 R2 are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. • PostScript 3 is a trademark of Adobe System, Inc. • USFT® and MicroType™ are registed trademarks of Monotype Imaging Inc. • iPad, iPhone, iPod touch, TrueType, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S and other countries. AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple Inc. • LaserWriter is a trademark of Apple Inc. • All other brand or product names are trademarks of their respective companies or organizations. Refer to the 'LICENSE.txt' file in the provided CD-ROM for the open source license information. REV. 1.01Safety information_ 3 safety information These warnings and precautions are included to prevent injury to you and others, and to prevent any potential damage to your machine. Be sure to read and understand all of these instructions before using the machine. Use common sense for operating any electrical appliance and whenever using your machine. Also, follow all warnings and instructions marked on the machine and in the accompanying literature. After reading this section, keep it in a safe place for future reference. IMPORTANT SAFETY SYMBOLS This section explains the meanings of all icons and signs in the user's guide. These safety symbols are in order, according to the degree of danger. Explanation of all icons and signs used in the user’s guide: Warning Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in severe personal injury or death. Caution Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in minor personal injury or property damage. Do not attempt. Do not disassemble. Do not touch. Unplug the power cord from the wall socket. Make sure the machine is grounded to prevent electric shock. Call the service center for help. Follow directions explicitly. OPERATING ENVIRONMENT Warning Do not use if the power cord is damaged or if the electrical outlet is not grounded. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Do not bend, or place heavy objects on the power cord. ► Stepping on or allowing the power cord to be crushed by a heavy object could result in electric shock or fire. Do not place anything on top of the machine (water, small metal or heavy objects, candles, lit cigarettes, etc.). ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Do not remove the plug by pulling on the cord; do not handle the plug with wet hands. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Safety information_ 4 Caution During an electrical storm or for a period of non-operation, remove the power plug from the electrical outlet. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. If the plug does not easily enter the electrical outlet, do not attempt to force it in. ► Call an electrician to change the electrical outlet, or this could result in electric shock. Be careful, the paper output area is hot. ► Burns could occur. Do not allow pets to chew on the AC power, telephone or PC interface cords. ► This could result in electric shock or fire and/or injury to your pet. If the machine has been dropped, or if the cabinet appears damaged, unplug the machine from all interface connections and request assistance from qualified service personnel. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. If the machine does not operate properly after these instructions have been followed, unplug the machine from all interface connections and request assistance from qualified service personnel. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. If the machine exhibits a sudden and distinct change in performance, unplug the machine from all interface connections and request assistance from qualified service personnel. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. OPERATING METHOD Caution Do not forcefully pull the paper out during printing. ► It can cause damage to the machine. When printing large quantities, the bottom part of the paper output area may get hot. Do not allow children to touch. ► Burns can occur. Be careful not to put your hand between the machine and paper tray. ► You may get injured. When removing jammed paper, do not use tweezers or sharp metal objects. ► It can damage the machine. Do not block or push objects into the ventilation opening. ► This could result in elevated component temperatures which can cause damage or fire. Do not allow too many papers to stack up in the paper output tray. ► It can damage the machine. Be care when replacing paper or removing jammed paper. ► New paper has sharp edges and can cause painful cuts. This machine's power interception device is the power cord. ► To switch off the power supply, remove the power cord from the electrical outlet. If the machine gets overheated, it releases smoke, makes strange noises, or generates an odd odor, immediately turn off the power switch and unplug the machine. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Safety information_ 5 INSTALLATION / MOVING Warning Do not place the machine in an area with dust, humidity or water leaks. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Caution Before moving the machine, turn the power off and disconnect all cords. Then lift the machine: •If the machine weighs under 20 kg (44.09lb), lift with 1 person. • If the machine weighs 20 kg (44.09lb) - 40kg (88.18lb), lift with 2 people. • If the machine weighs more than 40 kg (88.18lb), lift with 4 or more people. ► The machine could fall, causing injury or machine damage. Do not put a cover over the machine or place it in an airtight location, such as a closet. ► If the machine is not well-ventilated, this could result in fire. Do not place the machine on an unstable surface. ► The machine could fall, causing injury or machine damage. Make sure you plug the power cord into a grounded electrical outlet. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. The machine should be connected to the power level which is specified on the label. ► If you are unsure and want to check the power level you are using, contact the electrical utility company. Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords. ► This can diminish performance, and could result in electric shock or fire. Use only No.26 AWGa a. AWG: American Wire Gauge or larger, telephone line cord, if necessary. ► Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine. Use the power cord supplied with your machine for safe operation. If you are using a cord which is longer than 2 meters (6 feet) with a 140V machine, then the gauge should be 16 AWG or larger. ► Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine, and could result in electric shock or fire. MAINTENANCE / CHECKING Caution Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning the inside of the machine. Do not clean the machine with benzene, paint thinner or alcohol; do not spray water directly into the machine. ► This could result in electric shock or fire. Keep cleaning supplies away from children. ► Children could get hurt.Safety information_ 6 SUPPLY USAGE Caution Do not disassemble the toner cartridge. ► Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested. When storing supplies such as toner cartridges, keep them away from children. ► Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested. Do not burn any of the supplies such as toner cartridge or fuser unit. ► This could cause an explosion or uncontrollable fire. Using recycled supplies, such as toner, can cause damage to the machine. ► In case of damage due to the use of recycled supplies, a service fee will be charged. When changing the toner cartridge or removing jammed paper, be careful not to let toner dust touch your body or clothes. ► Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested. When toner gets on your clothing, do not use hot water to wash it. ► Hot water sets toner into fabric. Use cold water. When you are working inside the machine replacing supplies or cleaning the inside, do not operate the machine. ► You could get injured. Do not disassemble, repair or rebuild the machine by yourself. ► It can damage the machine. Call a certified technician when the machine needs repair. Keep the power cable and the contact surface of the plug clean from dust or water. ► Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire. To clean and operate the machine, strictly follow the user's guide provided with the machine. ► Otherwise, you could damage the machine. Do not remove any covers or guards that are fastened with screws. ► The machine should only be repaired by a Samsung service technician. Fuser units should only be repaired by a certified service technician. ► Repair by non-certified technicians could result in fire or electric shock. Regulatory information_ 7 regulatory information This machine is designed for a normal work environment and certified with several regulatory statements. LASER SAFETY STATEMENT The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J for Class I(1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1:1993 + A1:1997 + A2:2001. Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance or prescribed service condition. • Wavelength: 800 nm • Beam divergence - Paraller: 13 degrees - Perpendicular: 35 degrees • Maximum power or energy output: 12 mW WARNING Never operate or service the printer with the protective cover removed from Laser/Scanner assembly. The reflected beam, although invisible, can damage your eyes. When using this product, these basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce risk of fire, electric shock, and injury to persons: OZONE SAFETY During normal operation, this machine produces ozone. The ozone produced does not present a hazard to the operator. However, it is advisable that the machine be operated in a well ventilated area. If you need additional information about ozone, contact your local Samsung dealer.Regulatory information_ 8 POWER SAVE This printer contains advanced energy conservation technology that reduces power consumption when it is not in active use. When the printer does not receive data for an extended period of time, power consumption is automatically lowered. ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR mark are registered U.S. marks. For more information on the ENERGY STAR program see http://www.energystar.gov. RECYCLING Recycle or dispose of the packaging material for this product in an environmentally responsible manner. CHINA ONLY CORRECT DISPOSAL OF THIS PRODUCT (WASTE ELECTRICAL & ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT) (Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate collection systems) This marking shown on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable) should not be disposed of with other household wastes at the end of its working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, separate this from other types of wastes and recycle it responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources. Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and how they can take this item for environmentally safe recycling. Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for disposal. RADIO FREQUENCY EMISSIONS FCC Information to the User This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: • This device may not cause harmful interference, and • This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:Regulatory information_ 9 • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or experienced radio TV technician for help. Change or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Canadian Radio Interference Regulations This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class B limits for radio noise emissions from digital apparatus as set out in the interference-causing equipment standard entitled “Digital Apparatus”, ICES-003 of the Industry and Science Canada. Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques applicables aux appareils numériques de Classe B prescrites dans la norme sur le matériel brouilleur: “Appareils Numériques”, ICES-003 édictée par l’Industrie et Sciences Canada. UNITED STATES OF AMERICA Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Intentional emitter per FCC Part 15 Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be present (embedded) in your printer system. This section is only applicable if these devices are present. Refer to the system label to verify the presence of wireless devices. Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for use in the United States of America if an FCC ID number is on the system label. The FCC has set a general guideline of 20 cm (8 inches) separation between the device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the body (this does not include extremities). This device should be used more than 20 cm (8 inches) from the body when wireless devices are on. The power output of the wireless device (or devices), which may be embedded in your printer, is well below the RF exposure limits as set by the FCC. This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. Operation of this device is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to use it. Contact manufacturer for service. FCC Statement for Wireless LAN use: While installing and operating this transmitter and antenna combination the radio frequency exposure limit of 1m W/cm2 may be exceeded at distances close to the antenna installed. Therefore, the user must maintain a minimum distance of 20cm from the antenna at all times. This device cannot be colocated with another transmitter and transmitting antenna. TURKEY ONLY GERMANY ONLYRegulatory information_ 10 RUSSIA ONLY REPLACING THE FITTED PLUG (FOR UK ONLY) Important The mains lead for this machine is fitted with a standard (BS 1363) 13 amp plug and has a 13 amp fuse. When you change or examine the fuse, you must re-fit the correct 13 amp fuse. You then need to replace the fuse cover. If you have lost the fuse cover, do not use the plug until you have another fuse cover. Contact the people from you purchased the machine. The 13 amp plug is the most widely used type in the UK and should be suitable. However, some buildings (mainly old ones) do not have normal 13 amp plug sockets. You need to buy a suitable plug adaptor. Do not remove the moulded plug. If you cut off the moulded plug, get rid of it straight away. You cannot rewire the plug and you may receive an electric shock if you plug it into a socket. Important warning: You must earth this machine. The wires in the mains lead have the following color code: • Green and Yellow: Earth • Blue: Neutral • Brown: Live If the wires in the mains lead do not match the colors marked in your plug, do the following: You must connect the green and yellow wire to the pin marked by the letter “E” or by the safety ‘Earth symbol’ or colored green and yellow or green. You must connect the blue wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “N” or colored black. You must connect the brown wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “L” or colored red. You must have a 13 amp fuse in the plug, adaptor, or at the distribution board. DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (EUROPEAN COUNTRIES) Approvals and Certifications The CE marking applied to this product symbolizes Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Declaration of Conformity with the following applicable 93/68/EEC Directives of the European Union as of the dates indicated: SCX-3200 Series: Low Voltage Directive (2006/95/EC), EMC Directive (2004/108/EC) SCX-3205W(K): R&TTE Directive (1999/5/EC) The declaration of conformity may be consulted at www.samsung.com/printer, go to Support > Download center and enter your printer (MFP) name to browse the EuDoC. January 1, 1995: Council Directive 2006/95/EC Approximation of the laws of the member states related to low voltage equipment. January 1, 1996: Council Directive 2004/108/EC (92/31/EEC), approximation of the laws of the Member States related to electromagnetic compatibility. March 9, 1999: Council Directive 1999/5/EC on radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment and the mutual recognition of their conformity. A full declaration, defining the relevant Directives and referenced standards can be obtained from your Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. representative.Regulatory information_ 11 EC Certification Certification to 1999/5/EC Radio Equipment & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive (FAX) This Samsung product has been self-certified by Samsung for pan-European single terminal connection to the analogue public switched telephone network (PSTN) in accordance with Directive 1999/5/EC. The product has been designed to work with the national PSTNs and compatible PBXs of the European countries: In the event of problems, you should contact the Euro QA Lab of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. in the first instance. The product has been tested against TBR21. To assist in the use and application of terminal equipment which complies with this standard, the European Telecommunication Standards Institute (ETSI) has issued an advisory document (EG 201 121) which contains notes and additional requirements to ensure network compatibility of TBR21 terminals. The product has been designed against, and is fully compliant with, all of the relevant advisory notes contained in this document. European Radio Approval Information (for products fitted with EU-approved radio devices) Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz band, may be present (embedded) in your printer system which is intended for home or office use. This section is only applicable if these devices are present. Refer to the system label to verify the presence of wireless devices. Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for use in the European Union or associated areas if a CE mark with a Notified Body Registration Number and the Alert Symbol is on the system label. The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in you printer is well below the RF exposure limits as set by the European Commission through the R&TTE directive. European States qualified under wireless approvals: EU Austria, Belgium, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France (with frequency restrictions), Germany, Greece, Hungary, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Malta, The Netherlands, Poland, Portugal, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden and the U.K. EEA/EFTA countries Iceland, Liechtenstein, Norway and Switzerland European States with restrictions on use: EU In France, the frequency range is restricted to 2446.5-2483.5 MHz for devices above 10 mW transmitting power such as wireless EEA/EFTA countries No limitations at this time REGULATORY COMPLIANCE STATEMENTS Wireless Guidance Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be present (embedded) in your printer system. The following section is a general overview of considerations while operating a wireless device. Additional limitations, cautions, and concerns for specific countries are listed in the specific country sections (or country group sections). The wireless devices in your system are only qualified for use in the countries identified by the Radio Approval Marks on the system rating label. If the country you will be using the wireless device in, is not listed, contact your local Radio Approval agency for requirements. Wireless devices are closely regulated and use may not be allowed. The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in your printer is well below the RF exposure limits as known at this time. Because the wireless devices (which may be embedded into your printer) emit less energy than is allowed in radio frequency safety standards and recommendations, manufacturer believes these devices are safe for use. Regardless of the power levels, care should be taken to minimize human contact during normal operation. As a general guideline, a separation of 20 cm (8 inches) between the wireless device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the body (this does not include extremities) is typical. This device should be used more than 20 cm (8 inches) from the body when wireless devices are on and transmitting. This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. Some circumstances require restrictions on wireless devices. Examples of common restrictions are listed below: Radio frequency wireless communication can interfere with equipment on commercial aircraft. Current aviation regulations require wireless devices to be turned off while traveling in an airplane. IEEE 802.11 (also known as wireless Ethernet) and Bluetooth communication devices are examples of devices that provide wireless communication.Regulatory information_ 12 OPENSSL LICENSE Copyright (c) 1998-2001 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)". 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without Prior written permission. For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org. 5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written permission of the OpenSSL Project. 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)". THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT "AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). ORIGINAL SSLEAY LICENSE Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights reserved. This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL. This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are adhered to. The following conditions apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com). Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. In environments where the risk of interference to other devices or services is harmful or perceived as harmful, the option to use a wireless device may be restricted or eliminated. Airports, Hospitals, and Oxygen or flammable gas laden atmospheres are limited examples where use of wireless devices may be restricted or eliminated. When in environments where you are uncertain of the sanction to use wireless devices, ask the applicable authority for authorization prior to use or turning on the wireless device. Every country has different restrictions on the use of wireless devices. Since your system is equipped with a wireless device, when traveling between countries with your system, check with the local Radio Approval authorities prior to any move or trip for any restrictions on the use of a wireless device in the destination country. If your system came equipped with an internal embedded wireless device, do not operate the wireless device unless all covers and shields are in place and the system is fully assembled. Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to use it. Contact manufacturer for service. Only use drivers approved for the country in which the device will be used. See the manufacturer System Restoration Kit, or contact manufacturer Technical Support for additional information.Regulatory information_ 13 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement: "This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)" The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the routines from the library being used are not cryptographic related. 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement: "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)". THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. The licence and distribution terms for any publicly available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.Regulatory information_ 14 CHINA ONLYAbout this user’s guide_ 15 about this user’s guide This user’s guide provides information about basic understanding of the machine as well as detailed explanation on each step during actual usage. It is a valuable resource for both novice and professional users for the proper installation and use of the machine. • Read the safety information before using the machine. • If you have a problem using the machine, refer to the troubleshooting chapter (See "Troubleshooting" on page 77). • Terms used in this user’s guide are explained in the glossary chapter (See "Glossary" on page 96). • Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its options or models. • The procedures in this user’s guide are mainly based on Windows XP. CONVENTION Some terms in this guide are used interchangeably, as below: • Document is synonymous with original. • Paper is synonymous with media, or print media. • Machine refers to printer or MFP. The following table offers the conventions of this guide: CONVENTION DESCRIPTION EXAMPLE Bold For texts on the display or button names on the machine. Power Note Provides additional information or details for the machine function and feature. The date format may differ from country to country. Caution Contains information you can use to protect the machine from possible mechanical damage or malfunction. Do not touch the surface of the drum located in the toner cartridge or imaging unit. Footnote Provides additional information on certain words or a phrases. a. pages per minute (“Cross-reference”) Refers you to additional detailed information. (See "Finding more information" on page 16).About this user’s guide_ 16 FINDING MORE INFORMATION You can find information about setting up and using your machine in the following resources, either as a print-out or on screen. MATERIAL NAME DESCRIPTION Quick Installation Guide This guide provides information on setting up your machine. This guide is provided in the box with the printer. User’s Guide This guide provides you with step-by-step instructions for using your machine’s full features, maintaining your machine, troubleshooting, and replacing supplies. Machine Driver Help This help provides you with information about the printer driver and instructions for setting up the options for printing (See "Using help" on page 56). Samsung website If you have Internet access, you can get help, support, machine drivers, manuals, and order information from the Samsung website, www.samsung.com/printer. Downloadable software You can download useful software programs from the Samsung website. • Samsung AnyWeb Print: helps personal users to screen-capture the website screen in Windows Internet Explorer easily. (http://solution.samsungprinter.com/personal/anywebprint) • SyncThru™ Web Admin Service: provides convenient tools for network administrators who need to manage many machines simultaneously. This program is for network model only. (http://solution.samsungprinter.com, See "Features by Models" on page 18)Features of your new product_ 17 features of your new product Your new machine is equipped with a number of special features that improve the quality of the documents you print. SPECIAL FEATURES Print with excellent quality and speed • You can print with a resolution of up to 1200 x 1200 dpi effective output. • Your machine prints A4-sized paper at up to 16 ppm and letter-sized paper at up to 17 ppm. Handle many different types of printable material • The 150-sheet tray supports plain paper in various sizes, letterhead, envelopes, labels, custom-sized media, postcards, and heavy paper. Create professional documents • Print Watermarks. You can customize your documents with words, such as “Confidential” (See "Using watermarks" on page 57). • Print Posters. The text and pictures of each page of your document are magnified and printed across the sheet of paper and can then be taped together to form a poster (See "Printing posters" on page 56). • You can use preprinted forms and letterhead with plain paper (See "Using overlays" on page 58). Save time and money • To save paper, you can print multiple pages on one single sheet of paper (See "Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper" on page 56). • This machine automatically conserves electricity by substantially reducing power consumption when not in use. • To save paper, you can print on both sides of the paper manually (See "Printing on both sides of the paper (Manual)" on page 56). Print in various environments • You can print with various operating systems such as Windows, Linux, and Macintosh OS systems. • Your machine is equipped with a Hi-Speed USB 2.0 interface. • Your machine comes with a built-in network interface, Ethernet 10/100 BaseTX. SCX-3205W(K) only) • Your machine comes with a built-in network interface 802.11 b/g/n wireless LAN. (SCX-3205W(K) only) For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Copy the original in high quality • You can copy the original and print them in enhanced image quality and size. Scan the originals • Scan in color and use the precise compressions of BMP, JPEG, TIFF and PDF formats. • Use one button to scan your original to the connected computer. Eco Print • You can reduce toner and paper usage (See "Eco Print button" on page 22). IPv6 (SCX-3205W(K) only) • The machine supports IPv6 (See "IPv6 Configuration" on page 34). AirPrint AirPrint allows you to wirelessly print directly from iPhone, iPad and iPod touch running iOS 4.2 or later.Features of your new product_ 18 FEATURES BY MODELS The machine is designed to support all of your document needs from printing to more advanced networking solutions for your business. Features by models include: FEATURES SCX-3200 SERIES SCX-3205W(K) SERIES Print ● ● Eco Print ● ● Duplex (2-sided) printing (manual) ● ● Copy ● ● Scan ● ● Hi-Speed USB 2.0 ● ● Print Screen ● IPv6 ● Network Interface Ethernet 10/100 Base TX wired LAN ● Network Interface 802.11b/g/n wireless LANa a.Depending on your country, wireless LAN card may not be available. For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought your machine. ● SyncThru™ Web Service ● (●: Included, Blank: Not included) Introduction_ 19 1.introduction This chapter gives you an overview of your machine: This chapter includes: • Machine overview • Control panel overview • Understanding the status LED • Introducing the useful buttons MACHINE OVERVIEW Front view 3 6 1 10 11 12 9 7 8 5 4 2 13 14 This illustration may differ from your machine depending on its model. 1 Scanner lid 6 Front door 11 Inner cover 2 Scanner glass 7 Tray 12 Toner cartridge 3 Control panel 8 Paper length guide 13 Toner cartridge handle 4 Output tray (face down) 9 Paper width guide 14 Toner cartridge drum 5 Output support 10 Scan unitIntroduction_ 20 Rear view 1 2 3 This illustration may differ from your machine depending on its model. 1 USB port 2 Power cord receptacle 3 Network porta a.SCX-3205W(K) onlyIntroduction_ 21 CONTROL PANEL OVERVIEW This control panel may differ from your machine depending on its model. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 13 12 1 Power ( ) Allows you to turn the power on or off (See "Power button" on page 23). 2 Eco Print Turn the Eco mode on or off (See "Eco Print button" on page 22). 3 Scan to Sends scanned data (See "Scanning originals and sending to your computer (Scan to PC)" on page 64). 4 ID Copy Allows you to copy both sides the ID card like a driver’s license to a single side of paper (See "ID card copying" on page 63). 5 Front LED When the LED lights on, place the front side of an ID card facing down on the scanner glass (See "ID card copying" on page 63). 6 Back LED When the LED lights on, place the back side of an ID card facing down on the scanner glass (See "ID card copying" on page 63). 7 Display Shows the number of pages you want to copy. 8 +/- Buttons Allows you to increase/decrease the number of page you want to copy (See "+/- buttons" on page 22). 9 Print Screen (SCX-3200 only) Prints the displayed screen of your monitor (See "Print Screen button (SCX-3200 only)" on page 22). WPS (SCX-3205W(K) only) Allows you to turn on or off the wireless network connection (See "WPS button (SCX-3205W(K))" on page 22). 10 Stop/Clear ( ) Stops an operation at any time and there are more functions (See "Stop/Clear button" on page 23). 11 Start ( ) Begins a printing, copying or scanning job depending on which function you are using. 12 Wireless LED (SCX-3205W(K) only) Shows the current status of the wireless network connection (See "Understanding the status LED" on page 22). 13 Status LED Shows the status of your machine (See "Understanding the status LED" on page 22).Introduction_ 22 UNDERSTANDING THE STATUS LED Status LED The color of the LED indicates the machine's current status. STATUS LED DESCRIPTION Off • The machine is off-line. • The machine is in sleep mode. Green On • The machine is in ready mode or warming up. Blinking • When the LED blinks slowly, the machine is receiving data from the computer or printing documents. • When the LED blinks rapidly, the machine is operating special functions. Red On • The inner cover is opened. Close the inner cover completely. • There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in the tray. • The machine has stopped due to a major error. • Your system has some problems. If this problem occurs, contact a service representative. • A toner cartridge has almost reached its estimated cartridge lifea a.Estimated cartridge life means the expected or estimated toner cartridge life, which indicates the average capacity of print-outs and is designed pursuant to ISO/IEC 19752. The number of pages may be affected by operating environment, percentage of image area, printing interval, media type, and media size. Some amount of toner may remain in the cartridge even when red LED is on and the printer stops printing. . It is recommended to replace the toner cartridge (See "Replacing the toner cartridge" on page 89). Blinking • A small amount of toner is left in the cartridge. The estimated cartridge lifea of toner is close. Prepare a new cartridge for replacement. You may temporarily increase the printing quality by redistributing the toner (See "Redistributing toner" on page 77). • The machine is printing in manual feed mode or in manual duplex mode. Orange On A paper jam has occurred (See "Clearing paper jams" on page 78). Samsung does not recommend using a non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge such as one that is refilled or remanufactured. Samsung cannot guarantee a non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge's quality. Service or repair required as a result of using non-genuine Samsung toner cartridges will not be covered under the machine warranty. All printing errors will appear in the Smart Panel program window. If the problem persists, contact a service representative. Wireless LED (SCX-3205W(K) only) WIRELESS LED STATUS DESCRIPTION Blue Off ( ) Wireless network is disconnected. On ( ) Wireless network is connected. Slowly blinks ( ) The machine starts connecting to a wireless network. Fast blinks ( ) • The machine is connecting to access point (or wireless router). • Wireless network connection is being disconnected. INTRODUCING THE USEFUL BUTTONS Print Screen button (SCX-3200 only) If you press Print Screen button for less than two seconds, the green light blinks fast on the Status LED, and then the machine prints the whole screen displayed in the monitor. If you press Print Screen button for more than two seconds, the Status LED lights on green, and then the machine prints an active screen displayed in the monitor. • The page will be printed on the default page like A4 or Letter. • Print Screen can only be used in the Windows and Macintosh operating systems. • You can only use this function with a USB-connected machine. • You can use this function only when the Smart Panel program is installed and running. • You can only use this function in Eco Print mode off. Eco Print button You can turn the Eco Print mode on or off by simply pressing the button. If you set the Eco Print mode on, the machine automatically sets the 2-UP and Toner Save option on and print with those options. 1. Press Eco Print button on the control panel. 2. Eco Print LED lights on. Then, Eco Print mode is on. To turn off Eco Print mode, press Eco Print button one more time. +/- buttons You can determine the number of copies (up to 99 copies) you want to copy by pressing +/- buttons. The default setting value is 1. • If you press +/- buttons briefly, the number of copies increases/decreases by single digits. • If you press +/- buttons long, the number of copies increases/decreases by ten-fold. WPS button (SCX-3205W(K)) This feature automatically detects which WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup™) mode your access point uses. By pushing a button on the wireless LAN router/access point and the machine, you can setup the wireless network and security settings (See "Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))" on page 36).Introduction_ 23 Stop/Clear button By pressing Stop/Clear button, you can do the following functions. FUNCTION DESCRIPTION Printing a configuration report In ready mode, press and hold this button long enough (about two seconds) until the Status LED blinks slowly, and release the button (See "To print a configuration report" on page 24). Printing a network configuration report (SCX-3205W(K) only) In ready mode, press and hold this button for four seconds until the Status LED blinks fast, and release the button (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). Supplies information report In the ready mode, press and hold this button for about 6 seconds until the Status LED is on, and release (See "To print a supplies information report" on page 24). Canceling print job Press Stop/Clear button during a operation. The print job is cleared from both the machine and the computer and then the machine returns to ready mode. This may take some time depending on the size of the print job. Power button By pressing Power button, you can turn the machine on or off. Turning on the machine 1. Plug in the power cord. 2. Press Power button on the control panel. When the machine is powered on, you can see LED looping on the display. Then, the machine is in ready mode. If you want to turn the power off, press and hold this button for about two seconds.Getting started_ 24 2.getting started This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the USB connected machine and software. This chapter includes: • Setting up the hardware • Printing a report • Supplied software • System requirements • Installing USB connected machine’s driver • Sharing your machine locally SETTING UP THE HARDWARE This section shows the steps to set up the hardware, as is explained in the Quick Installation Guide. Make sure you read the Quick Installation Guide first and follow the steps below: Location 1. Select a stable location. Select a level, stable place with adequate space for air circulation. Allow extra space for opening cover(s) and tray(s). The area should be well ventilated and away from direct sunlight or sources of heat, cold, and humidity. Do not set the machine close to the edge of your desk or table. Printing is suitable for altitudes under 1,000 m (3,281 ft). Refer to the altitude setting to optimize your printing (See "Altitude adjustment" on page 46). Place the machine on a flat, stable surface so that there is no incline greater than 2 mm (0.08 inch). Otherwise, printing quality may be affected. 2mm (0.08 in) 2mm (0.08 in) 2. Unpack the machine and check all the enclosed items. 3. Remove tape holding the machine securely. 4. Install the toner cartridge. 5. Load paper (See "Loading originals" on page 48). 6. Make sure that all cables are connected to the machine. 7. Turn the machine on (See "Turning on the machine" on page 23). This machine will not operate when the power main fails. PRINTING A REPORT Print a configuration or supplies information page to make sure that the machine is operating properly. To print a configuration report In the ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about two seconds) until the Status LED blinks slowly, and release. For SCX-3205W(K), you can print a network configuration report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). To print a supplies information report In the ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for about six seconds until the Status LED lights on, and release. SUPPLIED SOFTWARE After you have set up your machine and connected it to your computer, you must install the printer software. If you are a Windows or Macintosh OS user, install the software from the supplied CD and if you are a Linux OS user, download the software from the Samsung website (www.samsung.com/printer) and install. Machine software is occasionally updated for reasons like the release of new operating system and etc. If needed, download the latest version from the Samsung website (www.samsung.com/printer).OS CONTENTS Windows • Printer driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your machine’s features. • Scanner driver: TWAIN and Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) drivers are available for scanning documents on your machine. • Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs during printing (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). • SmarThrua : a.Allows you to edit a scanned image in various ways using a powerful image editor and to send the image by email. You can also open another image editor program such as Adobe Photoshop, from SmarThru. For details, refer to the on-screen help supplied on the SmarThru program (See "SmarThru" on page 70). This program is the accompanying Windows-based software for your multifunctional machine. • Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: You can find out about Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program information and installed scan driver's condition. • Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set up printer’s other options from your computer. • SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP addresses. (SCX-3205W(K) only) Macintosh • Printer Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your machine’s features. • Scanner driver: TWAIN driver is available for scanning documents on your machine. • Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs during printing (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). • Samsung Scan and Fax Manager: You can find out about Samsung Scan and Fax Manager program information and installed scan driver's condition. • Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set up printer’s other options from your computer. • SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP addresses. (SCX-3205W(K) only) Linux • Unified Linux Driver: Use this driver to take full advantage of your machine’s features. • SANE: Use this driver to scan documents. • Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor the machine’s status and alerts you when an error occurs during printing (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). • Printer Settings Utility: This program allows you to set up printer’s other options from your computer. • SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/IP addresses. (SCX-3205W(K) only) Getting started_ 25 SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS Before you begin, ensure that your system meets the following requirements: Windows Your machine supports the following Windows operating systems. OPERATING SYSTEM REQUIREMENT (RECOMMENDED) CPU RAM FREE HDD SPACE Windows® 2000 Intel® Pentium® II 400 MHz (Pentium III 933 MHz) 64 MB (128 MB) 600 MB Windows® XP Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (256 MB) 1.5 GB Windows Server® 2003 Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz) 128 MB (512 MB) 1.25 GB to 2 GB Windows Server® 2008 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz) 512 MB (2 GB) 10 GB Windows Vista® Intel® Pentium® IV 3 GHz 512 MB (1 GB) 15 GB Windows® 7 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 32-bit or 64-bit processor or higher 1 GB (2 GB) 16 GB • Support for DirectX® 9 graphics with 128 MB memory (to enable the Aero theme). • DVD-R/W Drive Windows Server® 2008 R2 Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (x86) or 1.4 GHz (x64) processors (2 GHz or faster) 512 MB (2 GB) 10 GB • Internet Explorer® 5.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for all Windows operating systems. • Windows Terminal Services is compatible with your machine. Macintosh OPERATING SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (RECOMMENDED) CPU RAM FREE HDD SPACE Mac OS X 10.3 ~ 10.4 • Intel® Processors • PowerPC G4/ G5 • 128 MB for a PowerPC based Mac (512 MB) • 512 MB for a Intel-based Mac (1 GB) 1 GBGetting started_ 26 Linux ITEM REQUIREMENTS Operating system RedHat® Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64 bit) Fedora 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12 (32/64 bit) SuSE Linux 10.0, 10.1 (32 bit) OpenSuSE® 10.2, 10.3, 11.0, 11.1, 11.2 (32.64 bit) Mandriva 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2009.1 (32/64 bit) Ubuntu 5.04, 5.10, 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04, 8.10, 9.04, 9.10 (32/64 bit) SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11 (32/64 bit) Debian 4.0, 5.0 (32/64 bit) CPU Pentium IV 2.4 GHz (Intel Core™2) RAM 512 MB (1 GB) Free HDD space 1 GB (2 GB) INSTALLING USB CONNECTED MACHINE’S DRIVER A locally connected machine is a machine directly connected to your computer by a USB cable. Only use a USB cable no longer than 3 m (10 ft.). Windows You can install the machine software using the typical or custom method. The following steps are recommended for most users who use a machine directly connected to your computer. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the computer and powered on. If the “Found New Hardware Wizard” window appears during the installation procedure, click Cancel to close the window. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window will appear. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM Drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM Drive and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account Control window. 3. Select Install now. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list. • For SCX-3205W(K), you can access the Wireless Setting and Installation menu. The menu allows you to install a wireless network to connect to the machine with an USB cable (See "Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))" on page 36). • The Advanced Installation has two options, Custom Installation and Install Software Only. The Custom Installation allows you to select the machine’s connection and choose individual component to install. The Install Software Only allows you to install the supplied software, such as Smart Panel. Follow the instruction on the window. 4. Read the License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. The software searches for the machine. If your machine is not connected to the computer, the following Mac OS X 10.5 • Intel® Processors • 867 MHz or faster Power PC G4/ G5 512 MB (1 GB) 1 GB Mac OS X 10.6 • Intel® Processors 1 GB (2 GB) 1 GB OPERATING SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS (RECOMMENDED) CPU RAM FREE HDD SPACEGetting started_ 27 window will appear. • After connecting the machine, click Next. • Check if you want to install the software without connection of the printer. - Check this option to install the software without a machine connected. In this case, the print a test page window will be skipped, and completes the installation. • Search again When you press this button, the firewall notice window appears. - Turn off the firewall and Search again. For Windows operating system, click Start > Control Panel > Windows Firewall, and inactivate this option. - Turn off the firewall from the third party's program beside the operating system. Refer to the manual provided by individual programs. • Direct Input The Direct Input allows you to search a specific machine on the network. - Search by IP address: Enter the IP address or the host name. Then click Next. To verify your machine’s IP address, print a network configuration report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). - Search by network path: To find a shared machine (UNC Path), enter the shared name manually or find a shared printer by clicking the Browse button. Then click Next. • Help - This help button gives you the detailed information about how to connect the machine. 5. The searched machines will be shown on the screen. Select the one you wish to use and click Next. If the software searched only one machine, the confirmation window appears. 6. After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 8. 7. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 8. If you want to register your machine on Samsung web site, click On-line Registration. If your machine is not connected yet to the network or computer, click How to connect?. How to connect? gives detailed information about how to connect the machine. Follow the instructions in the window. 9. Click Finish. If the printer driver does not work properly, follow the steps below to repair or reinstall the driver. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your machine and powered on. b) From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Uninstall. c) Select the option you wish to execute, then follow the instruction on the window. Macintosh 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 3. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 4. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 5. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 6. Enter the password and click OK. 7. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 8. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 9. Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 10.Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual components to install. 11.When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears, click Continue. 12.Select Typical installation for a network printer for a network printer and then click OK. 13.After the installation is finished, click Restart. 14.Open the Applications folder > Utilities > Print Setup Utility. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 15.Click Add on the Printer List. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, click the “+” icon; a display window will pop up. 16.For Mac OS X 10.3, select the USB tab. • For Mac OS X10.4, click Default Browser and find the USB connection. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, click Default and find the USB connection. 17.For Mac OS X 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Printer Model and your machine name in Model Name. • For Mac OS X 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Print Using and your machine name in Model. • For Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Select a driver to use... and your machine name in Print Using. Your machine appears on the Printer List, and is set as the default machine. 18.Click Add.Getting started_ 28 If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow steps below to uninstall the driver for Macintosh. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. b) Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. c) Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. d) Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. e) Double-click the Installer OS X icon. f) Enter the password and click OK. g) The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. h) Read the license agreement and click Continue. i) Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. j) Select Uninstall and click Uninstall. k) When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears, Click Continue. l) When the uninstall is done, click Quit. Linux You need to download Linux software packages from the Samsung website to install the printer software. Follow the steps below to install the software. Installing the Unified Linux Driver 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. 3. From the Samsung website, download the Unified Linux Driver package to your computer. 4. Right-click the Unified Linux Driver package and extract the package. 5. Double-click cdroot > autorun. 6. When the welcome screen appears, click Next. 7. When the installation is complete, click Finish. The installation program added the Unified Driver Configurator desktop icon and the Unified Driver group to the system menu for your convenience. If you have any difficulties, consult the on screen help that is available through your system menu or from the driver package Windows applications, such as Unified Driver Configurator. Installing the Smart Panel 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. 3. From the Samsung website, download the Smart Panel package to your computer. 4. Right-click the Smart Panel package and extract the package. 5. Double-click cdroot > Linux > smartpanel > install.sh. Installing the Printer Settings Utility 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. 2. When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. 3. From the Samsung website, download the Printer Settings Utility package to your computer. 4. Right-click the Printer Settings Utility package and extract the package. 5. Double-click cdroot > Linux > psu > install.sh. If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow the steps below steps to uninstall the driver for Linux. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. b) When the Administrator Login window appears, type in “root” in the Login field and enter the system password. You must log in as a super user (root) to uninstall the printer driver. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator. c) Click the icon at the bottom of the desktop. When the Terminal screen appears, type in: [root@localhost root]#cd /opt/Samsung/mfp/uninstall/ [root@localhost uninstall]#./uninstall.sh d) Click Uninstall. e) Click Next. f) Click Finish.Getting started_ 29 SHARING YOUR MACHINE LOCALLY Follow the steps below to set up computers to share your machine locally. If the Host computer is directly connected to the machine by a USB cable and is also connected to the local network environment, the client computer connected to the local network can use the shared machine through the host computer to print. 2 1 1 Host computer A computer which is directly connected to the machine by USB cable. 2 Client computers Computers which use the machine shared through the host computer. Windows Setting up a host computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s driver" on page 26). 2. Click the Windows Start menu. 3. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printers and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 4. Right-click the printer icon. 5. For Windows XP/Vista/Server 2003/Server 2008, press Properties. For Windows 7/Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select the Printer properties. If Printer properties item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with the selected printer. 6. Select the Sharing tab. If you are a Windows 7/Windows Server 2008 R2 user, check the Change Sharing Options. 7. Check the Share this printer checkbox. 8. Fill in the Share Name field. Click OK. Setting up a client computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Installing USB connected machine’s driver" on page 26). 2. Click the Windows Start menu. 3. Select All programs > Accessories > Windows Explorer. 4. Enter the IP address of the host computer in the address bar and press Enter in your keyboard. In case host computer requires a User name and Password, fill in User ID and password of the host computer account. 5. Right-click the printer icon you want to share and select Connect. 6. If a set up complete message appears, click OK. 7. Open the file you want to print and start printing. Macintosh The following steps are for Mac OS X 10.5~10.6. Refer to Mac Help for other OS versions. Setting up a host computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Macintosh" on page 27). 2. Open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 3. Select the printer to share in the Printers list. 4. Select Share this printer. Setting up a client computer 1. Install your printer driver (See "Macintosh" on page 27). 2. Open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 3. Click the “+” icon. A display window showing the name of your shared printer appears. 4. Select your machine and click Add. Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 30 3.network setup (scx-3205w(k) only) This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the network connected machine and software. This chapter includes: • Network environment • Introducing useful network programs • Using a wired network • Installing network connected machine’s driver • IPv6 Configuration NETWORK ENVIRONMENT You need to set up the network protocols on the machine to use it as your network machine. You can set up the basic network settings through the network setting programs. The following table shows the network environments supported by the machine. ITEM REQUIREMENTS Network interface • Ethernet 10/100 Base-TX • 802.11b/g/n Wireless LANa a.Depending on your country, wireless LAN card may not be available. For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought your machine. Network operating system • Windows 2000/Server 2003 /Server 2008/XP/Vista/7/Server 2008 R2 • Various Linux OS • Mac OS X 10.3 ~ 10.6 Network protocols • TCP/IPv4 • DHCP, BOOTP • DNS, WINS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP • Standard TCP/IP Printing (RAW), LPR, IPP • SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP • TCP/IPv6 (DHCP, DNS, RAW, LPR, SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP) (See "IPv6 Configuration" on page 34.) Wireless security • Authentication: Open System, Shared Key, WPA Personal, WPA2 Personal (PSK) • Encryption: WEP64, WEP128, TKIP, AES INTRODUCING USEFUL NETWORK PROGRAMS There are several programs available to setup the network settings easily in network environment. For the network administrator especially, managing several machines on the network is possible. Before using the programs below, set the IP address first. SyncThru™ Web Service Web server embedded on your network machine, which allows you to do the following tasks. • You can configure the network parameters necessary for the machine to connect to various network environments. • You can customize machine settings (See "Using SyncThru™ Web Service (SCX-3205W(K) only)" on page 69). SyncThru™ Web Admin Service Web-based machine management solution for network administrator. SyncThru™ Web Admin Service provides you with an efficient way of managing network devices and lets you remotely monitor and troubleshoot network machines from any site with corporate internet access. • Download this program from http://solution.samsungprinter.com. SetIP This utility program allows you to select a network interface and manually configure the IP addresses for use with the TCP/IP protocol. • See "IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Windows)" on page 31. • See "IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh)" on page 31. • See "IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Linux)" on page 32. TCP/IPv6 is not supported by this program. USING A WIRED NETWORK You must set up the network protocols on your machine to use it on your network. This chapter will show you how this is easily accomplished. You can use network after connecting network cable to a corresponding port on your machine. Printing a network configuration report You can print a network configuration report from the machine’s control panel that will show the current machine’s network settings. This will help you to set up a network and troubleshoot problems.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 31 1. Press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about four seconds) until the Status LED blinks fast. 2. Then, release the button. Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC address and IP address. For example: • MAC Address:00:15:99:41:A2:78 • IP Address:192.0.0.192 Setting IP address First, you have to set up an IP address for network printing and managements. In most cases a new IP address will be automatically assigned by a DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server located on the network. In a few situations the IP address must be set manually. This is called a static IP and is often required in corporate Intranets for security reasons. • DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the report. • Static IP assignment: Use SetIP program to change the IP address from your computer. If your machine has a control panel, you can also change IP address using the machine's control panel. In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network administrator to set IP address for you. IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Windows) This program is for manually setting the network IP address of your machine using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. A MAC address is the hardware serial number of the network interface and can be found in the Network Configuration Report. Before using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall by performing the following steps. 1. Open Control Panel. 2. Double-click Security Center. 3. Click Windows Firewall. 4. Disable the firewall. Installing the program 1. Insert the Printer Software CD-ROM provided with your machine. When the driver CD runs automatically, close that window. 2. Start Windows Explorer and open the X drive (X represents your CD-ROM drive). 3. Double-click Application > SetIP. 4. Double-click Setup.exe to install this program. 5. Select a language, then click Next. 6. Follow the instructions in the window and complete the installation. Starting the program 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Turn on the machine. 3. From the Windows Start menu, select All Programs > Samsung Printers > SetIP > SetIP. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer. For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address). • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Click Apply, and then click OK. The machine will automatically print the Network Configuration Report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. 7. Click Exit to close the SetIP program. 8. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh) For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by performing the following. 1. Open System Preferences. 2. Click Security. 3. Click the Firewall menu. 4. Turn firewall off. The following instructions may vary from your model. 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Insert the Installation CD-ROM, and open the disk window, select MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPapplet.html. 3. Double-click the file and Safari will automatically open, then select Trust. The browser will open the SetIPapplet.html page that shows the printer’s name and IP address information. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 32 For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address). • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Select Apply, then OK, and OK again. The printer will automatically print the configuration report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. Quit Safari. You may close and eject the installation CD-ROM. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. You have successfully changed the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway. IPv4 setting using SetIP Program (Linux) SetIP program should be automatically installed during the printer driver installation. 1. Print the machine’s network configuration report to find your machine’s MAC address. 2. Open the /opt/Samsung/mfp/share/utils/. 3. Double-click the SetIPApplet.html file. 4. Click to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the network card’s MAC address, IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, and then click Apply. When you enter the MAC address, enter it without a colon(:). 6. The machine prints the network information. Confirm all the settings are correct. 7. Close the SetIP program. Network parameter setting You can also set up the various network settings through the network administration programs such as SyncThru™ Web Admin Service and SyncThru™ Web Service. Restoring factory default settings You may need to reset the machine to the factory default settings when machine that you are using is connected to new network environment. Restoring factory default settings using SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari or Firefox and enter your machine’s new IP address in the browser window. For example: 2. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service. 3. Click Login on the upper right of the website. The Login window appears. 4. Type in the ID and Password, and then click Login. If it is your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the below default ID and password. • ID: admin • Password: sec00000 5. Click Settings > Network Settings. 6. Click Restore Default on the left pane of the website. 7. Click Clear. 8. Click Yes when the confirmation window appears. 9. Click OK when the success window appears. 10.Turn off and restart machine to apply settings. INSTALLING NETWORK CONNECTED MACHINE’S DRIVER Windows You can set up the machine driver, follow the steps below. This is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to the network or USB and powered on. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window appears. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM drive and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control windows. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows 7 or Windows 2008 Server R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Yes in the User Account Control windows. 3. Select Install Now. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list. • For SCX-3205W(K), you can access Wireless Setting and Installation menu. The Wireless Setting and Installation allows you to install a wireless network to connect to the machine with a USB cable (See "Setting a wireless network with USB cable" on page 38). • The Advanced Installation has two options, Custom Installation and Install Software Only. The Custom Installation allows you to select the machine’s connection and choose individual component to install. The Install Software Only allows you to install the supplied software such as the Smart Panel. Follow the instruction on the window. 4. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. The program searches for the machine. If your machine is not found in the network or locally, the error Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 33 message appears. • Check if you want to install the software without connection of the printer. - Check this option to install this program without a machine connected. In this case, the print a test page window will be skipped, and completes the installation. • Search again When you press this button, the firewall notice window appears. - Turn off the firewall and Search again. For Windows operating system, click Start > Control Panel > Windows Firewall, and inactivate this option. - Turn off the firewall from the third party's program beside the operating system. Refer to the manual provided by individual programs. • Direct Input The Direct Input allows you to search a specific machine on the network. - Search by IP address: Enter the IP address or the host name. Then click Next. To verify your machine’s IP address, print a network configuration report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). - Search by network path: To find a shared machine (UNC Path), enter the shared name manually or find a shared printer by clicking the Browse button. Then click Next. • Help If your machine is not connected to the computer or network, this help button gives detailed information about the how to connect the machine. 5. The searched machine will be shown on the screen. Select the one you wish to use and click Next. If the driver searched only one machine, the confirmation window appears. 6. After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and go to step 8. 7. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 8. If you want to register your machine on Samsung website, click On-line Registration. If your machine is not connected yet to the network, click How to connect?. How to connect? gives you the detailed information about the how to connect the machine. Follow the instructions in the window. 9. Click Finish. • After the driver setup is completed, you may enable firewall. • If your printer driver does not work properly, follow the step below to repair or reinstall the driver. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your machine and powered on. b) From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Uninstall. c) Select the option as you wish, follow the instruction on the window. Macintosh 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set. 2. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 3. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 4. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 5. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 6. Enter the password and click OK. 7. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 8. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 9. Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 10.Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual components to install. 11.When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears. Click Continue. 12.Select Typical installation for a network printer for a network printer and then click OK. 13.The SetIP program automatically runs. If the machine has already configured network information, close the SetIP program. 14.Click OK to continue the installation. 15.After the installation is finished, click Restart. 16.Open the Applications folder > Utilities > Print Setup Utility. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, open the Applications folder > System Preferences and click Print & Fax. 17.Click Add on the Printer List. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click the “+” icon. A display window will pop up. 18.For Mac OS X 10.3, select the IP Printing tab. • For Mac OS X 10.4, click IP Printer. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click IP. 19.Select HP Jetdirect - Socket in Protocol. When printing a document containing many pages, printing performance may be enhanced by choosing Socket for Printer Type option. 20.Enter the machine’s IP address in the Address input field.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 34 21.Enter the queue name in the Queue input field. If you cannot determine the queue name for your machine server, try using the default queue first. 22.For Mac OS X 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Printer Model and your machine name in Model Name. • For Mac OS X 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select Samsung in Print Using and your machine name in Model. • For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly, choose Select Printer Software and your machine name in Print Using. Your machine appears on the Printer List, and is set as the default machine. 23.Click Add. If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it. Follow steps below to uninstall the driver for Macintosh. a) Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on. b) Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. c) Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. d) Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. e) Double-click the Installer OS X icon. f) Enter the password and click OK. g) The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. h) Read the license agreement and click Continue. i) Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. j) Select Uninstall and click Uninstall. k) When the message which warns that all applications will close on your computer appears, click Continue. l) When the uninstall is done, click Quit. Linux Install Linux Driver and add network Printer 1. Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set. 2. Download the Unified Linux Driver package from the Samsung website. 3. Extract the UnifiedLinuxDriver.tar.gz file and open the new directory. 4. Double-click the Linux folder. 5. Double-click the install.sh icon. 6. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 7. The Add printer wizard window opens. Click Next. 8. Select Network printer and click Search button. 9. The Printer’s IP address and model name appears on list field. 10.Select your machine and click Next. 11.Input the printer description and Next 12.When the add printer is done, click Finish 13.When the install is done, click Finish Add network Printer 1. Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator. 2. Click Add Printer… 3. The Add printer wizard window opens. Click Next. 4. Select Network printer and click the Search button. 5. The printer’s IP address and model name appears on list field. 6. Select your machine and click Next. 7. Input the printer description and Next 8. When the add printer is done, click Finish. IPV6 CONFIGURATION TCP/IPv6 is supported properly only in Windows Vista or higher. If the IPv6 network seems to not be working, set all the network setting to the factory defaults and try again (See "Restoring factory default settings" on page 32). In the IPv6 network environment, follow the next procedure to use the IPv6 address. 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Turn on the machine. 3. Print a Network Configuration Report from the machine’s control panel that will check IPv6 addresses (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). 4. Select Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printer > Add Printer. 5. Click Add a local printer on the Add Printer windows. 6. Follow the instruction on the window. 7. The Add Printer Wizard window appears. Follow the instruction on the window. If the machine does not work in the network environment, activate IPv6. Refer to the next section followed by. Printing a network configuration report You can print a network configuration report from the machine’s control panel that will show the current machine’s network settings. This will help you to set up a network and troubleshoot problems. 1. In ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about four seconds) until the Status LED blinks fast. 2. Then, release the button. Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC address and IP address. For example: • MAC Address:00:15:99:41:A2:78 • IP Address:192.0.0.192 Setting IPv6 addresses Machine supports the following IPv6 addresses for network printing and managements. • Link-local Address: Self-configured local IPv6 address (Address starts with FE80). • Stateless Address: Automatically configured IPv6 address by a network router. • Stateful Address: IPv6 address configured by a DHCPv6 server. • Manual Address: Manually configured IPv6 address by a user.Network setup (SCX-3205W(K) only)_ 35 Manual address configuration 1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer that supports IPv6 addressing as a URL (See "Using SyncThru™ Web Service (SCX-3205W(K) only)" on page 69). For IPv4, enter the IPv4 address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address field and press the Enter key or click Go. 2. When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Network Settings. 3. Click TCP/IPv6. 4. Enable the Manual Address In the TCP/IPv6 section. 5. Select the Address/Prefix and click the Add button, then the router prefix will automatically be entered into the address field. Enter the rest of address. (ex: 3FFE:10:88:194::AAAA. “A” is the hexadecimal 0 through 9, A through F.) 6. Click the Apply button. Installing printer driver Driver installation for network printer in IPv6 network environment is same as TCP/IPv4 (See "Installing network connected machine’s driver" on page 32). Select TCP/IP Port and when the list of machines are displayed, simply select your machine's IPv6 address. Using SyncThru™ Web Service 1. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer that supports IPv6 addressing as a URL. 2. Select one of the IPv6 addresses (Link-local Address, Stateless Address, Stateful Address, Manual Address) from Network Configuration Report (See "Printing a network configuration report" on page 30). 3. Enter the IPv6 addresses (ex: http://[FE80::215:99FF:FE66:7701]). Address must be enclosed in '[ ]' brackets.Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 36 4.wireless network setup (scx-3205w(k)) This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the wireless network connected machine and software. This chapter includes: • Setting a wireless network with the WPS button • Using a wireless network from the computer • Setting a wireless network with USB cable • Setting a wireless network with network cable • Completing the installation • Troubleshooting For more information about the network environment, network programs, and installing network connected machine’s driver, refer to the following chapters. • See "Network environment" on page 30. • See "Introducing useful network programs" on page 30. • See "Installing network connected machine’s driver" on page 32. SETTING A WIRELESS NETWORK WITH THE WPS BUTTON You can install a wireless network with the WPS ( ) button. After compleleting the wireless network connection, you need to install a machine driver to print from an application (See "Installing network connected machine’s driver" on page 32). Setting a wireless network with the WPS button If your machine and an access point (or wireless router) support Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS), you can easily configure the wireless network settings by pressing the WPS ( ) button on the control panel. If you want to use the wireless network using the infrastructure mode, make sure that the network cable is disconnected from the machine. Using the WPS (PBC) button or entering the PIN number from the computer to connect to the Access Point varies depending on the access point (or wireless router) you are using. Refer to the user's guide of the access point (or wireless router) you are using. Items to prepare You need to ensure you have the following items ready to use: • Check if the access point (or wireless router) supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS). • Check if your machine supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS). • Networked computer (PIN mode only) Refer to your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless network, for information about your network configuration. Choosing your network connection There are two methods to connect your machine to a wireless network using the WPS ( ) button on the control panel. The Push Button Configuration (PBC) method allows you to connect your machine to a wireless network by pressing both the WPS ( ) button on the control panel of your machine and the WPS (PBC) button on a Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS)-enabled access point (or wireless router) respectively. The Personal Identification Number (PIN) method helps you connect your machine to a wireless network by entering the supplied PIN information on a Wi-Fi Protected Setup™(WPS)-enabled access point (or wireless router). Factory default in your machine is PBC mode, which is recommended for a typical wireless network environment. Connecting to a wireless network in PBC mode To connect your machine to the wireless network in PBC mode, follow the following steps: You need to check the status of the wireless LED. 1. Press and hold the WPS ( ) button on the control panel for about 2 - 4 seconds until the status LED blinks quickly. • : The light blinks slowly on wireless LED. The machine starts connecting to the wireless network. The LED blinks slowly for up to two minutes until you press the PBC button on access point (or wireless router). 2. : Press the WPS (PBC) button on the access point (or wireless router). The wireless LED blinks in the order below: a) : The light blinks fast on the wireless LED. The machine is connecting to the access point (or wireless router). b) : When the machine is successfully connected to the wireless network, the wireless LED light stays on. Connecting to the wireless network in PIN mode To connect your machine to the wireless network, follow the following steps: You need to check the status of the wireless LED. 1. The network configuration report including PIN number must be printed. In ready mode, press and hold the Stop/Clear button on the control panel for about 5 seconds. You can find your machine’s PIN number. 2. Press and hold the WPS ( ) button on the control panel for more than 4 seconds until the status LED on. • : The light blinks slowly on the wireless LED. The machine starts connecting to access point (or wireless router). 3. You need to enter eight-digit PIN number within two minutes to the computer which is connected to the access point (or wireless router). The LED blinks slowly for up to two minutes until you enter the eight-digit PIN number The wireless LED blinks in the order below: a) : The light blinks fast on the wireless LED. The machine is Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 37 connecting to the access point (or wireless router). b) : When the machine is successfully connected to the wireless network, the wireless LED light stays on. Re-connecting to the wireless network When the wireless function is off, the machine automatically tries to re-connect to the access point (or wireless router) with the previously used wireless connection settings and address. In the following cases, the machine automatically re-connects to the wireless network: • The machine is turned off and on again. • The access point (or wireless router) is turned off and on again. Canceling a wireless network connection process To cancel the wireless network connection function when the machine is connecting to the wireless network, press and release the Stop/Clear button on the control panel. You need to wait 2 minuites to re-connect the wireless network. Disconnecting a wireless network connection To disconnect the wireless network connection, press the WPS ( ) button on the control panel for more than two seconds. • When the Wi-Fi Network is in idle mode: The machine is immediately disconnected from the wireless network, and the wireless LED is off. • When the Wi-Fi Network is being used: While the machine waits until the current job is finished, the light blinks fast on the wireless LED. Then, the wireless network connection is automatically disconnected. The wireless LED is off. When the Wi-Fi Network is disconnected, press the WPS ( ) button on the control panel. The Wi-Fi network is on and the setting a wireless network begins. USING A WIRELESS NETWORK FROM THE COMPUTER Choosing your network connection Typically, you can only have one connection between your computer and the machine at a time. There are types of network connections to consider. • Wireless network without access point (Ad-Hoc mode) • Wireless network with an access point (Infrastructure mode) How to print a network configuration report You can identify the network settings of your machine by printing a network configuration report. To print the report: 1. In ready mode, press and hold Stop/Clear button on the control panel for long enough (about four seconds) until the Status LED blinks fast. 2. Then, release the button. Using this Network Configuration Report, you can find your machine MAC address and IP address. For example: • MAC Address:00:15:99:41:A2:78 • IP Address:192.0.0.192 IP addresses Every device in a network has a unique numerical address called an IP Address. Your machine came with a Default IP address of 192.0.0.192, which you can verify by printing out a Network Configuration Report or Configuration Report. • DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the report. • Static IP assignment: Use the SetIP program to change the IP address from your computer (See "Setting IP address" on page 31). In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network administrator to set this address for you. Wireless network name and network key Wireless networks require higher security, so when an access point is first set up, a network name (SSID), the type of security used, and a Network Key are created for the network. Locate this information before proceeding with the machine installation. Infrastructure mode This is an environment generally used for homes and SOHOs. This mode uses an access point to communicate with the wireless machine. • See "Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Windows)" on page 38. • See "Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Macintosh)" on page 40. Ad-Hoc mode This mode does not use an access point. The wireless computer and wireless machine communicates directly. • See "Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Windows)" on page 39. • See "Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Macintosh)" on page 41. After choosing your configuration, follow the simple directions for your computer operating system, but first locate the software CD supplied with the machine before proceeding. Installing a wireless network with cables You can install a wireless network to connect to the machine with either a USB cable or a network cable. For most users, we recommend using a USB cable with the program provided in the supplied software CD. The following are two ways to install a wireless network with cables. • With a USB cable: You can simply set up a wireless network using the program in the supplied software CD. Only Windows and Macintosh operating system are supported (See "Setting a wireless network with USB cable" on page 38). You can also install a wireless network in Printer Settings Utility with USB cable after installing driver. (Windows and Macintosh operating system are supported.) • With a network cable: You can set up a wireless network using the SyncThru™ Web Service program (See "Setting a wireless network withWireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 38 network cable" on page 42). SETTING A WIRELESS NETWORK WITH USB CABLE Refer to your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless network, for information about your network configuration. Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Windows) Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Access point • Network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless interface • USB cable Creating the infrastructure network in Windows When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer, access point and machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window appears. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your CD-ROM and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account Control windows. 4. Select the Wireless Setting and Installation option. • Install Now: First you must configure the wireless network settings of your printer to print through wireless. • Wireless Setting and Installation: Configure the wireless network settings of your printer with a USB cable then install the printer driver. Press this button to set up the wireless connection if you have not set up the wireless connection before. 5. Read License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. 6. The software searches the wireless network. If the searching has failed, you may check if the USB cable is connected between the computer and machine properly, and follow the instruction on the window. 7. After searching, the window shows the wireless network devices. Select the name (SSID) of access point you are using and click Next. If you cannot find out the network name you want to choose, or if you want to set the wireless configuration manually, click Advanced Setting. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type the SSID of access point you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Infrastructure. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. WPA Personal or WPA2 Personal: Select this option to authenticate the print server based on WPA Pre-Shared Key. This uses a shared secret key (generally called Pre Shared Key pass phrase) which is manually configured on the access point and each of its clients. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128, TKIP, AES, TKIP AES) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window does appear when the access point has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. The window may differ according to its security mode, WEP or WPA. • In case of WEP Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and enter WEP security key. Click Next. WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. • In case of WPA Enter the WPA shared key and click Next. WPA authorizes and identifies users based on a secret key that changes automatically at regular intervals. WPA also uses TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol) and AES (Advanced Encryption Standard) for data encryption. 8. The window shows the wireless network setting and check if settings are right. Click Next. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the window. However, if it shows Static, click Change Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 39 TCP/IP to change the assignment method to DHCP. • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer is set to DHCP, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 9. When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. Click Next. 10. Wireless Network Setting Complete window appears. Then, click Next. Select Yes if you accept the current settings and continue the setup procedure. Select No if you want to return to the beginning screen. Then, click Next. 11.Click Next when the Confirm Printer Connection window appears. 12.Select the components to be installed. Click Next. After selecting the components, you can also change the machine name, set the machine to be shared on the network, set the machine as the default machine, and change the port name of each machine. Click Next. 13.After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 15. 14.If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 15.To register as a user of the machine in order to receive information from Samsung, click On-line Registration. 16.Click Finish. Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Windows) If you do not have an access point (AP), you may still connect the machine wirelessly to your computer by setting up an Ad-Hoc wireless network by following the simple steps below. Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Wireless network computer • Software CD provided with your machine • Wireless network machine • USB cable Creating the Ad-Hoc network in Windows When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer and the wireless network machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. • The software CD should automatically run and an installation window appear. • If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your drive. Click OK. • If you use Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2 click Start > All programs > Accessories > Run. Type X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter which represents your drive and click OK. • If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows Vista, Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run program field, and click Continue or Yes in the User Account Control windows. 4. Select the Wireless Setting and Installation option. • Install Now: First you must configure the wireless network settings of your printer to print through wireless. • Wireless Setting and Installation: Configure the wireless network settings of your printer with a USB cable then install the printer driver. Press this button to set up the wireless connection if you have not set up the wireless connection before. 5. Read the License Agreement, and select I accept the terms of the License Agreement. Then, click Next. 6. The software searches the wireless network. If the software has failed to search the network, check if the USB cable is connected properly between the computer and machine, and follow the instruction on the window. 7. After searching the wireless network, a list of wireless network your machine has searched appears. If you want to use the Samsung default ad-hoc setting, select the last wireless network on the list, which Network Name(SSID) is airportthru and Signal is Printer Self Network. Then, click Next. If you want to use other ad-hoc settings, select other wireless network from the list. If you want to change ad-hoc settings click the Advanced Setting button. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type in the SSID Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 40 name you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Ad-hoc. • Channel: Select the channel. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window appears when the ad-hoc network has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and click Next. • WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. 8. The window which shows the wireless network setting appears. Check the settings and click Next. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer’s network configuration is set to DHCP, the wireless network setting should also be DHCP. Likewise, if the computer’s network configuration is set to Static, the wireless network setting should also be Static. If your computer is set to DHCP and you want to use Static wireless network setting, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows Static, click Change TCP/IP to change the assignment method to Receive IP address automatically (DHCP). • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 9. When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. Click Next. If the Change PC Network Setting window appears, follow the steps on the window. Click Next if you are finished the computer’s wireless network settings. If you set the computer’s wireless network as DHCP, it will take several minutes to receive the IP address. 10.The Wireless Network Setting Complete window appears. Select Yes if you accept the current settings and continue the setup procedure. Select No if you want to return to the beginning screen. Then, click Next. 11.Click Next when the Confirm Printer Connection window appears. 12.Select the components to be installed. Click Next. After selecting the components, you can also change the machine name, set the machine to be shared on the network, set the machine as the default machine and change the port name of each machine. Click Next. 13.After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test page appears. If you want to print a test page, click Print a test page. Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 15. 14.If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes. If not, click No to reprint it. 15.To register as a user of the machine in order to receive information from Samsung, click On-line Registration. 16.Click Finish. Installing the machine on a wireless network with an access point (Macintosh) Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Access point • Network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless network interface • USB cable Creating the infrastructure network in Macintosh When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer, access point and machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 4. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 5. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 6. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 7. Enter the password and click OK. 8. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 9. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 10.Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 11.Select Easy Install and click Install.Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 41 Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual operations will be installed. 12.Select the Wireless Setting and Installation option. 13.The software searches the wireless network. If the searching has failed, you may check if the USB cable is connected between the computer and machine properly, and follow the instruction on the window. 14.After searching, the window shows the wireless network devices. Select the name (SSID) of access point you are using and click Next. When you set the wireless configuration manually, click Advanced Setting. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type the SSID of access point you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Infrastructure. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. WPA Personal or WPA2 Personal: Select this option to authenticate the print server based on WPA Pre-Shared Key. This uses a shared secret key (generally called Pre Shared Key pass phrase) which is manually configured on the access point and each of its clients. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128, TKIP, AES, TKIP AES) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window does appear when the access point has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. The window may differ according to its security mode, WEP or WPA. • In case of WEP Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and enter WEP security key. Click Next. WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. • In case of WPA Enter the WPA shared key and click Next. WPA authorizes and identifies users based on a secret key that changes automatically at regular intervals. WPA also uses TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol) and AES (Advanced Encryption Standard) for data encryption. 15.The window shows the wireless network setting and check if settings are right. Click Next. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the window. However, if it shows Static, click Change TCP/IP to change the assignment method to DHCP. • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer is set to DHCP, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 16.The wireless network is connecting according to the network configuration. 17.When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. 18.After the installation is finished, click Restart. Installing the machine on an Ad-Hoc wireless network (Macintosh) If you do not have a access point (AP), you may still connect the machine wirelessly to your computer by setting up an Ad-Hoc wireless network by following these simple directions. Items to prepare Ensure you have next items ready. • Wireless network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless network interface • USB cable Creating the Ad-Hoc network in Macintosh When the items are ready, follow below steps: 1. Check whether the USB cable is connected to the machine. 2. Turn on your computer and machine. 3. Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive. 4. Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh desktop. 5. Double-click the MAC_Installer folder. 6. Double-click the Installer OS X icon. 7. Enter the password and click OK. 8. The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue. 9. Read the license agreement and click Continue. 10.Click Agree to agree to the license agreement. 11.Select Easy Install and click Install. Easy Install is recommended for most users. All components necessary for machine operations will be installed. If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual operations will be Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 42 installed. 12.Click Wireless Setting and Installation. 13.The software searches the wireless network devices. If the searching has failed, you may check if the USB cable is connected between the computer and machine properly, and follow the instruction on the window. 14.After searching the wireless network, a list of wireless network your machine has searched appears. If you want to use the Samsung default ad-hoc setting, select the last wireless network on the list, which Network Name(SSID) is airportthru and Signal is Printer Self Network. Then, click Next. If you want to use other ad-hoc settings, select other wireless network from the list. If you want to change ad-hoc settings click the Advanced Setting button. • Enter the wireless Network Name: Type in the SSID name you want (SSID is case-sensitive). • Operation Mode: Select Ad-hoc. • Channel: Select the channel. • Authentication: Select an authentication type. Open System: Authentication is not used, and encryption may or may not be used, depending on the need for data security. Shared Key: Authentication is used. A device that has a proper WEP key can access the network. • Encryption: Select the encryption. (None, WEP64, WEP128) • Network Key: Enter the encryption network key value. • Confirm Network Key: Confirm the encryption network key value. • WEP Key Index: If you are using the WEP Encryption, select the appropriate WEP Key Index. The wireless network security window appears when the ad-hoc network has security setting. The wireless network security window appears. Select Open System or Shared Key for the authentication and click Next. • WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) is a security protocol preventing unauthorized access to your wireless network. WEP encrypts the data portion of each packet exchanged on a wireless network using a 64-bit or 128-bit WEP encryption key. 15.The window which shows the wireless network setting appears. Check the settings and click Next. Before entering the IP address for the machine, you must know the computer’s network configuration information. If the computer’s network configuration is set to DHCP, the wireless network setting should also be DHCP. Likewise, if the computer’s network configuration is set to Static, the wireless network setting should also be Static. If your computer is set to DHCP and you want to use Static wireless network setting, you must contact the network administrator to get the static IP address. • For the DHCP method If the IP address assignment method is DHCP, check if DHCP is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows Static, click Change TCP/IP to change the assignment method to Receive IP address automatically (DHCP). • For the Static method If the IP address assignment method is Static, check if Static is shown in the Wireless Network Setting Confirm window. However, if it shows DHCP, click Change TCP/IP to enter the IP address and other network configuration values for the machine. Example) If computer’s network information is as below: - IP address: 169.254.133.42 - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 Machine’s network information should be as below: - IP address: 169.254.133. 43 (Use computer’s IP address, with changed last three digits.) - Subnet Mask: 255.255.0.0 (Use the computer’s subnet mask.) - Gateway: 169.254.133.1 (Change the last three digits from IP address of your machine to 1.) 16.The wireless network is connecting according to the network configuration. 17.When the wireless network setting is completed, disconnect the USB cable between the computer and machine. 18.After the installation is finished, click Restart. SETTING A WIRELESS NETWORK WITH NETWORK CABLE Your machine is a network compatible machine. To enable your machine to work with your network you will need to perform some configuration procedures. Refer to your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless network, for information about your network configuration. Preparing items Ensure you have next items ready. • Access point • Network-connected computer • Software CD that provided with your machine • The machine installed with a wireless network interface • Network cable Setting IP address Firstly, you have to set up an IP address for network printing and managements. In most cases a new IP address will be automatically assigned by a DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server located on the network. In a few situations the IP address must be set manually. This is called a static IP and is often required in corporate Intranets for security reasons. • DHCP IP assignment: Connect your machine to the network, and wait a few minutes for the DHCP server to assign an IP address to the machine. Then, print the Network Configuration Report as explained above. If the report shows that the IP address has changed, the assignment was successful. You will see the new IP address in the report (See "How to print a network configuration report" on page 37). • Static IP assignment: Use SetIP program to change the IP address Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 43 from your computer. In an office environment, we recommend that you contact a network administrator to set this address for you. IP setting using SetIP Program (Windows) This program is for manually setting the network IP address of your machine using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. A MAC address is the hardware serial number of the network interface and can be found in the Network Configuration Report. For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by performing the following: 1. Open Start > All programs > Control Panel. 2. Double-click Security Center. 3. Click Windows Firewall. 4. Disable the firewall. Installing the program 1. Insert the Printer Software CD-ROM provided with your machine. When the driver CD runs automatically, close that window. 2. Start Windows Explorer and open the X drive. (X represents your CD-ROM drive.) 3. Double-click Application > SetIP. 4. Double-click Setup.exe to install this program. 5. Click OK. If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list. 6. Follow the instructions in the window and complete the installation. Starting the program 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Turned on the machine. 3. From the Windows Start menu, select All Programs > Samsung Printers > SetIP > SetIP. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer. For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X. (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address.) • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Click Apply, and then click OK. The machine will automatically print the Network Configuration Report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. 7. Click Exit to close the SetIP program. 8. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. IP setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh) For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by performing the following: The path and UIs may differ by Mac OS version. Refer to the Mac OS manual. 1. Open System Preferences. 2. Click Security. 3. Click the Firewall menu. 4. Turn firewall off. The following instructions may vary for your model. 1. Connect your machine to the network with a network cable. 2. Insert the Installation CD-ROM, and open the disk window, select MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPApplet.html. 3. Double-click the file and Safari will automatically open, then select Trust. The browser will open the SetIPApplet.html page that shows the printer’s name and IP address information. 4. Click on the icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the TCP/IP configuration window. 5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information assigned by a network manager before proceeding. • MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example, 00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8. • IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your printer. For example, if your computer’s IP address is 192.168.1.150, enter 192.168.1.X. (X is number between 1 and 254 other than the computer’s address.) • Subnet Mask: Enter a Subnet Mask. • Default Gateway: Enter a Default Gateway. 6. Select Apply, then OK, and OK again. The printer will automatically print the configuration report. Confirm that all the settings are correct. Quit Safari. You may close and eject the installation CD-ROM. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. You have successfully changed the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway. Configuring the machine’s wireless network Before starting you will need to know the network name(SSID) of your wireless network and the network key if it is encrypted. This information was set when the access point (or wireless router) was installed. If you do not know about your wireless environment, please ask the person who has set up your network. To configure wireless parameters, you can use SyncThru™ Web Service. Using SyncThru™ Web Service Before starting wireless parameter configuration, make sure cable connection status. Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 44 1. Check whether the network cable is connected to the machine. If not, connect the machine with a standard network cable. 2. Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari or Firefox and enter your machine’s new IP address in the browser window. For example, 3. Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website. The Login window appears. 4. Type in the ID and Password then click Login. If it’s your first time logging into SyncThru™ Web Service, type in the below default ID and password. • ID: admin • Password: sec00000 5. When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Network Settings. 6. Click Wireless > Wizard. Wizard will help you setup the wireless network configuration. However, if you want to set the wireless network directly, select Custom. 7. Select the one Network Name(SSID) in the list. • SSID: SSID (Service Set Identifier) is a name that identifies a wireless network. access points and wireless devices attempting to connect to a specific wireless network must use the same SSID. The SSID is case-sensitive. • Operation Mode: Operation Mode refers to the type of wireless connections (See "Wireless network name and network key" on page 37). - Ad-hoc: Allows wireless devices to communicate directly with each other in a peer-to-peer environment. - Infrastructure: Allows wireless devices to communicate with each other through an access point. If your network’s Operation Mode is Infrastructure, select the SSID of the access point. If the Operation Mode is Ad-hoc, select the machine’s SSID. Note that “airportthru” is the default SSID of your machine. 8. Click Next. If wireless security setting window appears, enter the registered password (network key) and click Next. 9. The confirmation window appears, please check your wireless setup. If the setup is right, click Apply. Disconnect the network cable (standard or network). Your machine should then start communicating wirelessly with the network. In case of Ad-hoc mode, you can use a wireless LAN and wired LAN simultaneously. COMPLETING THE INSTALLATION After you have installed your Samsung wireless network printer, print another copy of the Network Configuration Report and keep it for future reference. You are now ready to use your new Samsung wireless printer on your network. TROUBLESHOOTING Solve problems that might occur during wireless setting and installing the machine driver. Wireless network problems If problems occur while using the machine on a network, check the followings. Printers Not Found • Your machine may not be turned on. Turn on your computer and the machine. • USB cable is not connected between your computer and machine. Connect machine to your computer using the USB cable. • The machine does not support wireless network. Check the machine's user's guide included on the software CD supplied with your machine and prepare a wireless network machine. Connecting Failure - Not found SSID • The machine is unable to search network name (SSID) which you have selected or typed in. Check the network name (SSID) on your access point and try connecting again. • Your access point is not turned on. Turn on your access point. Connecting Failure - Invalid Security • You configured security incorrectly. Check the configured security on your access point and machine. Connecting Failure - General Connection Error • Your computer is not receiving a signal form your machine. Check the USB cable and your machine power. • When Temporal Key Integrity Protocol(TKIP) security is set up for the access point, connection might fail. Change the access point settings. Connecting Failure - Connected Wired Network • Your machine is connected with wired network cable. Remove the wired network cable from your machine. PC Connection Error • The configured network address is unable to connect between your computer and machine. - For DHCP network environment The print receives the IP address automatically (DHCP) when computer is configured to DHCP. - For Static network environment The machine uses the static address when computer is configured to static address. If you computer has following addresses, - IP address: 192.168.1.100 - Subnet address: 255.255.255.0 - Gateway address: 192.168.1.1 Type in the following address for your machine, - IP address: 192.168.1.101 - Subnet address: 255.255.255.0 - Gateway address: 192.168.1.1Wireless network setup (SCX-3205W(K))_ 45 Solving other problems If problems occur while using the machine on a network, check the followings. For information on access point (or wireless router), refer to its own user's guide. • Your computer, access point or machine may not be turned on. • Check the wireless reception around the machine. If the reception is far from the machine or there is an obstacle, you might have difficulty receiving the signal. • Cycle the power for access point (or wireless router), machine and computer. Sometimes cycling the power can recover network communication. • Check whether firewall software (V3 or Norton) is blocking the communication. If the computer and the machine is connected on a same network it cannot be searched, firewall software might be blocking the communication. Refer to the user's guide for the software to turn it off and try searching the machine again. • Check whether the machine's IP address is allocated correctly. You can check the IP address by printing the network configuration report. • Check whether access point (or wireless router) has a configured security (password). If it has a password, refer to the access point (or wireless router) administrator. • Check whether the machine's IP address. Reinstall the machine driver and change the settings to connect to the machine on the network. Due to the characteristics of DHCP, the allocated IP address could change if the machine is not used for a long time or if the access point has been reset. • Check the wireless environment. You might not be able to connect to the network in the infrastructure environment where you need to type in a user's information before connecting to access point (or wireless router). • This machine only supports IEEE 802.11 b/g/n and Wi-Fi. For some counties, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Other wireless communication (Bluetooth) is not supported. • When using the Ad-hoc mode, for operating systems such as Windows Vista, you might need to set the wireless connection setting every time you use the wireless machine. • You cannot use infrastructure mode and Ad-hoc mode at the same time for Samsung wireless network machine. • The machine is within the range of the wireless network. For most networks, the machine should be within 30 meters (100 feet) of the wireless access point (or wireless router). • The machine is located away from obstacles that could block the wireless signal. Remove any large metal objects between the access point (or wireless router) and the machine. Make sure the machine and wireless access point (or wireless router) are not separated by poles, walls, or support columns containing metal or concrete. • The machine is located away from other electronic devices that may interfere with the wireless signal. Many devices can interfere with the wireless signal, including baby monitors, motors, cordless phones, security system cameras, other wireless networks, and some Bluetooth devices.Basic setup_ 46 5.basic setup After installation is complete, you may want to set the machine’s default settings. Refer to the next section if you would like to set or change values. This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the machine. This chapter includes: • Altitude adjustment • Setting the default tray and paper • Using the power saving feature • Changing font setting ALTITUDE ADJUSTMENT The print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure, which is determined by the height of the machine above sea level. The following information will guide you on how to set your machine to the best print quality or best quality of print. Before you set the altitude value, determine the altitude where you are. 0 4,000 m (13,123 ft) 3,000 m (9,842 ft) 2,000 m (6,561 ft) 1,000 m (3,280 ft) 4 3 2 1 1 High 1 2 High 2 3 High 3 4 Normal You can altitude adjustment in Printer Settings Utility. 1. Double-click the Smart Panel icon on the Windows task bar (or Notification Area in Linux). You can also click Smart Panel on the status bar in Mac OS X (See "Using the Smart Panel program" on page 70). Or, if you are a Windows user, you can launch it from the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > your printer driver name > Smart Panel. 2. Click Printer Setting. 3. Click Setting > Altitude Adjustment. Select necessary options from the drop-down list. 4. Click the Apply button. If your machine is connected to a network, SyncThru™ Web Service screen appears automatically. This can be also adjusted via SyncThru™ Web Service. SETTING THE DEFAULT TRAY AND PAPER You can select the tray and paper you would like to keep using for printing job. From your computer Windows 1. Click the Windows Start menu. 2. For Windows 2000, select Settings > Printers. • For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printer and Faxes. • For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Printers. • For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. • For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware > Devices and Printers. 3. Right-click on your machine. 4. For Windows XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista, press Printing Preferences. For Windows 7/Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select the Printing Preferences. If Printing Preferences item has a ► mark, you can select other printer drivers connected with the selected printer. 5. Click Paper tab. 6. Select tray and its options, such as paper size and type. 7. Press OK. If you want to use special-sized paper such as a billing paper, select Edit... in the Paper tab in the Printing Preferences (See "Opening printing preferences" on page 55). Macintosh Macintosh does not support this function. Macintosh users need to change the default setting manually each time they want to print using other settings. 1. Open a Macintosh application and select the file you want to print. 2. Open the File menu and click Print. 3. Go to Paper Feed pane. 4. Set appropriate tray from which you want to print. 5. Go to Paper pane. 6. Set paper type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from which you want to print. 7. Click Print to print. Linux 1. Open Terminal Program. 2. When the Terminal screen appears, type in the following: [root@localhost root]# lpr